Juniper MX960 Hardware Guide
Juniper MX960 Hardware Guide
Juniper MX960 Hardware Guide
Guide
Modified: 2019-05-16
Juniper Networks, the Juniper Networks logo, Juniper, and Junos are registered trademarks of Juniper Networks, Inc. in the United States
and other countries. All other trademarks, service marks, registered marks, or registered service marks are the property of their respective
owners.
Juniper Networks assumes no responsibility for any inaccuracies in this document. Juniper Networks reserves the right to change, modify,
transfer, or otherwise revise this publication without notice.
The information in this document is current as of the date on the title page.
Juniper Networks hardware and software products are Year 2000 compliant. Junos OS has no known time-related limitations through the
year 2038. However, the NTP application is known to have some difficulty in the year 2036.
The Juniper Networks product that is the subject of this technical documentation consists of (or is intended for use with) Juniper Networks
software. Use of such software is subject to the terms and conditions of the End User License Agreement (“EULA”) posted at
https://support.juniper.net/support/eula/. By downloading, installing or using such software, you agree to the terms and conditions of
that EULA.
Part 1 Overview
Chapter 1 System Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
MX960 Router Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
Chapter 2 Chassis Components and Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
MX960 Chassis Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
MX960 Component Redundancy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
MX960 Router Hardware and CLI Terminology Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
MX960 Midplane Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
MX960 Rack-Mounting Hardware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
MX960 Craft Interface Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
MX960 Alarm Relay Contacts on the Craft Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
MX960 Alarm LEDs and Alarm Cutoff/Lamp Test Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
MX960 Component LEDs on the Craft Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
MX960 Host Subsystem LEDs on the Craft Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
MX960 Power Supply LEDs on the Craft Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
MX960 DPC and MPC LEDs on the Craft Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
MX960 FPC LEDs on the Craft Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
MX960 SCB LEDs on the Craft Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
MX960 Fan LEDs on the Craft Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
MX960 Cable Manager Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Chapter 3 Cooling System Components and Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
MX960 Cooling System Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
MX960 Fan LED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
Figure 183: Removing a DC Power Supply from the MX960 Router . . . . . . . . . . 478
Figure 184: MX960 with High-Capacity AC Power Supplies Installed . . . . . . . . . 479
Figure 185: MX960 AC Power Input Mode Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 480
Part 1 Overview
Chapter 1 System Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
Table 3: MX960 Router Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
Table 4: Switch Control Board Capacities for MX Series 5G Universal Routing
Platforms (Full-Duplex) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Chapter 2 Chassis Components and Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
Table 5: MX960 Router Hardware Components and CLI Terminology . . . . . . . . . 10
Table 6: Alarm LEDs and Alarm Cutoff/Lamp Test Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Table 7: Host Subsystem LEDs on the Craft Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Table 8: Power Supply LEDs on the Craft Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Table 9: DPC and MPC LEDs on the Craft Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Table 10: FPC LEDs on the Craft Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Table 11: SCB LEDs on the Craft Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Table 12: Fan LEDs on the Craft Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Chapter 4 Host Subsystem Components and Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Table 13: Routing Engine LEDs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Table 14: Routing Engine Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Table 15: Hardware Specifications of the RE-MX-X6, RE-MX-X8, RE-PTX-X8,
RCBPTX, RE-QFX10002-60C, and RE-PTX10002-60C Routing Engines . . . 32
Table 16: End-of-Life Routing Engine Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Chapter 5 Line Card Components and Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Table 17: DPCs Supported in MX240, MX480, and MX960 Routers . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Table 18: FPCs Supported by MX Series Routers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Table 19: PICs Supported by MX240, MX480, and MX960 Routers . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Table 20: AS MSC LEDs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Table 21: AS MXC LEDs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Table 22: MIC/MPC1 Compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Table 23: MIC/MPC2 Compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Table 24: MIC/MPC3 Compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Table 25: MIC/MPC6 Compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Table 26: MIC/MPC8 Compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
Table 27: MIC/MPC9 Compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
Table 28: MIC/MPC10003 Compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
Table 29: MICs Supported by MX240, MX480, MX960 and MX2008 Routers . . . 66
If the information in the latest release notes differs from the information in the
documentation, follow the product Release Notes.
Juniper Networks Books publishes books by Juniper Networks engineers and subject
matter experts. These books go beyond the technical documentation to explore the
nuances of network architecture, deployment, and administration. The current list can
be viewed at https://www.juniper.net/books.
If you want to use the examples in this manual, you can use the load merge or the load
merge relative command. These commands cause the software to merge the incoming
configuration into the current candidate configuration. The example does not become
active until you commit the candidate configuration.
If the example configuration contains the top level of the hierarchy (or multiple
hierarchies), the example is a full example. In this case, use the load merge command.
If the example configuration does not start at the top level of the hierarchy, the example
is a snippet. In this case, use the load merge relative command. These procedures are
described in the following sections.
1. From the HTML or PDF version of the manual, copy a configuration example into a
text file, save the file with a name, and copy the file to a directory on your routing
platform.
For example, copy the following configuration to a file and name the file ex-script.conf.
Copy the ex-script.conf file to the /var/tmp directory on your routing platform.
system {
scripts {
commit {
file ex-script.xsl;
}
}
}
interfaces {
fxp0 {
disable;
unit 0 {
family inet {
address 10.0.0.1/24;
}
}
}
}
2. Merge the contents of the file into your routing platform configuration by issuing the
load merge configuration mode command:
[edit]
user@host# load merge /var/tmp/ex-script.conf
load complete
Merging a Snippet
To merge a snippet, follow these steps:
1. From the HTML or PDF version of the manual, copy a configuration snippet into a text
file, save the file with a name, and copy the file to a directory on your routing platform.
For example, copy the following snippet to a file and name the file
ex-script-snippet.conf. Copy the ex-script-snippet.conf file to the /var/tmp directory
on your routing platform.
commit {
file ex-script-snippet.xsl; }
2. Move to the hierarchy level that is relevant for this snippet by issuing the following
configuration mode command:
[edit]
user@host# edit system scripts
[edit system scripts]
3. Merge the contents of the file into your routing platform configuration by issuing the
load merge relative configuration mode command:
For more information about the load command, see CLI Explorer.
Documentation Conventions
Caution Indicates a situation that might result in loss of data or hardware damage.
Laser warning Alerts you to the risk of personal injury from a laser.
Table 2 on page xxviii defines the text and syntax conventions used in this guide.
Bold text like this Represents text that you type. To enter configuration mode, type the
configure command:
user@host> configure
Fixed-width text like this Represents output that appears on the user@host> show chassis alarms
terminal screen.
No alarms currently active
Italic text like this • Introduces or emphasizes important • A policy term is a named structure
new terms. that defines match conditions and
• Identifies guide names. actions.
Italic text like this Represents variables (options for which Configure the machine’s domain name:
you substitute a value) in commands or
configuration statements. [edit]
root@# set system domain-name
domain-name
Text like this Represents names of configuration • To configure a stub area, include the
statements, commands, files, and stub statement at the [edit protocols
directories; configuration hierarchy levels; ospf area area-id] hierarchy level.
or labels on routing platform • The console port is labeled CONSOLE.
components.
< > (angle brackets) Encloses optional keywords or variables. stub <default-metric metric>;
# (pound sign) Indicates a comment specified on the rsvp { # Required for dynamic MPLS only
same line as the configuration statement
to which it applies.
[ ] (square brackets) Encloses a variable for which you can community name members [
substitute one or more values. community-ids ]
GUI Conventions
Bold text like this Represents graphical user interface (GUI) • In the Logical Interfaces box, select
items you click or select. All Interfaces.
• To cancel the configuration, click
Cancel.
> (bold right angle bracket) Separates levels in a hierarchy of menu In the configuration editor hierarchy,
selections. select Protocols>Ospf.
Documentation Feedback
We encourage you to provide feedback so that we can improve our documentation. You
can use either of the following methods:
• Online feedback system—Click TechLibrary Feedback, on the lower right of any page
on the Juniper Networks TechLibrary site, and do one of the following:
• Click the thumbs-up icon if the information on the page was helpful to you.
• Click the thumbs-down icon if the information on the page was not helpful to you
or if you have suggestions for improvement, and use the pop-up form to provide
feedback.
Technical product support is available through the Juniper Networks Technical Assistance
Center (JTAC). If you are a customer with an active Juniper Care or Partner Support
Services support contract, or are covered under warranty, and need post-sales technical
support, you can access our tools and resources online or open a case with JTAC.
• JTAC hours of operation—The JTAC centers have resources available 24 hours a day,
7 days a week, 365 days a year.
• Find solutions and answer questions using our Knowledge Base: https://kb.juniper.net/
To verify service entitlement by product serial number, use our Serial Number Entitlement
(SNE) Tool: https://entitlementsearch.juniper.net/entitlementsearch/
• Visit https://myjuniper.juniper.net.
Overview
• System Overview on page 3
• Chassis Components and Descriptions on page 7
• Cooling System Components and Descriptions on page 21
• Host Subsystem Components and Descriptions on page 25
• Line Card Components and Descriptions on page 35
• Power System Components and Descriptions on page 85
• Switch Control Board Components and Descriptions on page 95
System Overview
The MX960 chassis provides redundancy and resiliency. The hardware system is fully
redundant, including power supplies, fan trays, Routing Engines, and Switch Control
Boards.
The MX960 router is 16 rack units (U) tall. Three routers can be stacked in a single
floor-to-ceiling rack, for increased port density per unit of floor space. The router provides
14 slots that can be populated with 11 or 12 Dense Port Concentrators (DPCs) or Modular
Port Concentrators (MPCs), six Flexible PIC Concentrators (FPCs), and two Switch
Control Boards (SCBs) in nonredundant fabric configurations.
Fully populated, the MX960 router provides an aggregate switch fabric capacity of up
to 10.56 Tbps, with line-rate throughput on 264 10-Gigabit Ethernet ports, 22 100-Gigabit
Ethernet and 44 10-Gigabit Ethernet ports and 66 40-Gigabit Ethernet ports.
Description Capacity
Several types of DPCs are available. Each DPC includes either two or four Packet
Forwarding Engines (PFE). Each PFE enables a throughput of 10 Gbps.
Up to two PICs can be installed in each FPC. Fully populated, the MX960 supports up to
12 PICs.
Up to two Modular Interface Cards (MICs) can be installed in each MPC. Fully populated,
the MX960 supports up to 24 MICs.
MPCs support fixed interfaces or up to two Modular Interface Cards (MICs) that can be
installed in each MPC. Fully populated, the MX960 supports up to 22 MICs.
For a list of the supported DPCs, FPCs, MPCs, MICs, PICs, and SCBs, see the MX Series
Interface Module Reference.
Table 4: Switch Control Board Capacities for MX Series 5G Universal Routing Platforms (Full-Duplex)
Enhanced MX Switch Up to 480 Gbps (non-redundant Up to 1.92 Tbps Up to 5.76 Tbps Up to 10.56 Tbps
Control Board fabric configuration); 340 Gbps
(SCBE2-MX) (redundant fabric configuration)
Enhanced MX Switch Up to 240 Gbps (non-redundant Up to 930 Gbps Up to 2.79 Tbps Up to 5.25 Tbps
Control Board fabric configuration); 160 Gbps
(SCBE-MX) (redundant fabric configuration)
Switch Control Board Up to 240 Gbps (non-redundant Up to 465 Gbps Up to 1.39 Tbps Up to 2.6 Tbps
(SCB-MX) fabric configuration); 120 Gbps
(redundant fabric configuration)
The connections between interface cards and SCBs are organized in three groups:
• Switch fabric—Connects the interface cards and provides for packet transport between
DPCs, FPCs, and MPCs. Two SCBs provide one non-redundant fabric. Three SCBs are
required for a redundant fabric configuration.
The router chassis is a rigid sheet metal structure that houses all the other router
components (see Figure 1 on page 8, Figure 2 on page 9, and Figure 3 on page 9). The
chassis installs in many types of racks, including 800-mm deep (or larger) enclosed
cabinets, standard 19-in. equipment racks, or telco open-frame racks. Two types of
chassis are available for the MX960 router:
• The standard chassis measures 27.75 in. (70.49 cm) high, 17.37 in. (44.11 cm) wide
(excluding the mounting flanges and brackets), and 23.0 in. (58.42 cm) deep (from
the front-mounting flanges to the rear of the chassis). The standard cable manager
extends the depth to 28.0 in. (71.1 cm). Up to three routers can be installed in a 48-U
rack if the rack can handle their combined weight, which can be greater than 1,050 lb
(476.3 kg).
NOTE: The chassis depth with the high-capacity AC power supply is 30.6"
and the depth with high-capacity DC power supply is 32.8".
• The chassis with the extended cable manager installed measures 36.5 in. (92.7 cm)
high, 17.37 in. (44.11 cm) wide, and approximately 29.00 in. (73.7 cm) deep (from the
front-mounting flanges to the rear of the extended cable manager). Up to two routers
with the extended cable manager can be installed in a 48-U rack if the rack can handle
their combined weight, which can be greater than 748 lb (339.28 kg).
Mounting hardware includes front-mounting flanges on the front of the chassis, and two
center-mounting brackets attached to the center of the chassis.
Air exhaust
Input mode
switch
AC Power
supplies
g017591
Power supply
ejectors
Air exhaust
Input mode
switch
DC Power
supplies
Power supply
g017593
ejectors
A fully configured router is designed so that no single point of failure can cause the entire
system to fail. Only a fully configured router provides complete redundancy. All other
configurations provide partial redundancy. The following major hardware components
are redundant:
• Host subsystem—The host subsystem consists of a Routing Engine and an SCB. The
router can have one or two host subsystems. If two host subsystems are installed, one
functions as the master and the other functions as the backup. If the master host
subsystem (or either of its components) fails, the backup can take over as the master.
To operate, each host subsystem requires a Routing Engine installed directly into in
an SCB.
• Cooling system—The cooling system has redundant components, which are controlled
by the host subsystem. If one of the fans fails, the host subsystem increases the speed
of the remaining fans to provide sufficient cooling for the router indefinitely.
Craft Interface Panel CRAFT-MX960-S Front Panel Display “MX960 Craft Interface Overview”
on page 14
Cooling System
Fan tray FFANTRAY-MX960 Fan Tray “MX960 Cooling System
Description” on page 21
Filter tray FFILTER-MX960 N/A
FFILTER-MX960-HC N/A
Routing Engine See Supported Routing Engines by Router. “MX960 Routing Engine
Description” on page 26
Interface Modules
DPC See “DPCs Supported on MX240, MX480, and MX960 Routers” “MX960 Dense Port Concentrator
on page 38 in the MX Series Interface Module Reference. Description” on page 35
MIC See “MICs Supported by MX Series Routers” on page 65 in the “MX960 Modular Interface Card
MX Series Interface Module Reference. Description” on page 65
MPC See “MPCs Supported by MX Series Routers” on page 79 in the “MX960 Modular Port
MX Series Interface Module Reference. Concentrator Description” on
page 76
PIC See “PICs Supported by MX240, MX480, and MX960 Routers” “MX960 PIC Description” on
on page 50 in the MX Series Interface Module Reference. page 48
Power distribution Power Distribution Module Power Distribution Module “MX960 Power System Overview”
module (PDM) on page 85
The midplane is located toward the rear of the chassis and forms the rear of the card
cage (see Figure 4 on page 13). The line cards and SCBs install into the midplane from
the front of the chassis, and the power supplies install into the midplane from the rear
of the chassis. The cooling system components also connect to the midplane.
• Data path—Data packets are transferred across the midplane between the line cards
through the fabric ASICs on the SCBs.
• Signal path—The midplane provides the signal path to the line cards, SCBs, Routing
Engines, and other system components for monitoring and control of the system.
Figure 4: Midplane
• The large mounting shelf for mounting in four-post racks, cabinets, and open-frame
racks
• Installing the MX960 Mounting Hardware for a Four-Post Rack or Cabinet on page 185
The craft interface allows you to view status and troubleshooting information at a glance
and to perform many system control functions. It is hot-insertable and hot-removable.
The craft interface is located on the front of the router above the card cage and contains
LEDs for the router components, the alarm relay contacts, and alarm cutoff button. See
Figure 5 on page 14.
NOTE: At least one SCB must be installed in the router for the craft interface
to obtain power.
The craft interface has two alarm relay contacts for connecting the router to external
alarm devices (see Figure 6 on page 15). Whenever a system condition triggers either
the red or yellow alarm on the craft interface, the alarm relay contacts are also activated.
The alarm relay contacts are located on the upper right of the craft interface.
Related • Disconnecting the Alarm Relay Wires from the MX960 Craft Interface on page 303
Documentation
• Connecting the Alarm Relay Wires to the MX960 Craft Interface on page 245
Two large alarm LEDs are located at the upper right of the craft interface. The circular
red LED lights to indicate a critical condition that can result in a system shutdown. The
triangular yellow LED lights to indicate a less severe condition that requires monitoring
or maintenance. Both LEDs can be lit simultaneously.
A condition that causes an LED to light also activates the corresponding alarm relay
contact on the craft interface.
To deactivate red and yellow alarms, press the button labeled ACO/LT (for “alarm
cutoff/lamp test”), which is located to the right of the alarm LEDs. Deactivating an alarm
turns off both LEDs and deactivates the device attached to the corresponding alarm
relay contact on the craft interface.
Table 6 on page 15 describes the alarm LEDs and alarm cutoff button in more detail.
OFFLINE Red On steadily Host is installed but the Routing Engine is offline.
Red On steadily Power supply has failed or power input has failed.
interface. Slot 2/6 is for an additional DPC, FPC, MPC, or SCB. Table 9 on page 17 describes
the functions of the LEDs.
The standard cable manager (see Figure 7 on page 18) is a tray located below the line-card
cage, which has a row of fourteen dividers for securing the cables for each Dense Port
Concentrator (DPC), Modular Port Concentrator (MPC), Modular Interface Card (MIC),
or PIC.
You can use cable strips or other ties to gently secure the cables in the standard cable
manager. To secure the cables in place, loop the tie through the cable anchor and secure
the tie. You can pull the standard cable manager up and outward to lock it into the
maintenance position. This allows you to access the lower fan tray and the air filter.
Release handles
The extended cable manager allows you to route cables away from the front of the DPCs,
MPCs, MICs, and PICs, and provides additional access (see Figure 9 on page 19 and
Figure 8 on page 19).
The cooling system components work together to keep all router components within the
acceptable temperature range (see Figure 10 on page 22, Figure 11 on page 22,
Figure 12 on page 22, and Figure 13 on page 22). The router has two fan trays located in
the front of the router that install horizontally above and below the card cage. Each
normal-capacity fan tray contains six fans. High-capacity fan trays that contain twelve
fans can be installed in the upper and lower fan tray slots. The fan trays are hot-insertable
and hot-removable.
The MX960 requires high-capacity fan trays to satisfy cooling requirements for
high-density DPCs and MPCs. When replacing normal-capacity fan trays with
high-capacity fan trays, you must replace them in both the upper and lower fan trays.
Additionally, you must replace the front normal air filter tray with a high capacity filter
tray and air filter.
There is a single air intake in the front of the router. Air is pushed up through the card cage
and through the upper fan tray where it is exhausted out the upper rear of the system
through the larger air exhaust shown in Figure 10 on page 22.
At the bottom rear of the chassis, there is an air intake for power supply cooling. Air flows
over the power supplies and is exhausted out the rear of the chassis through the smaller
air exhaust below the main exhaust.
The host subsystem monitors the temperature of the router components. When the
router is operating normally, the fans function at lower than full speed. If a fan fails or
the ambient temperature rises above a threshold, the speed of the remaining fans is
automatically adjusted to keep the temperature within the acceptable range. If the
ambient maximum temperature specification is exceeded and the system cannot be
adequately cooled, the Routing Engine shuts down the system by disabling output power
from each PEM.
g004707
Figure 15: High-Capacity Filter Tray with Air Filter
Air filter
g006003
Air filter tray
Each fan has an LED that displays its status. The fan LEDs are located on the top left of
the craft interface. For more information, see “MX960 Fan LEDs on the Craft Interface”
on page 18.
The host subsystem provides the routing and system management functions of the
router. You can install one or two host subsystems on the router. Each host subsystem
functions as a unit; the Routing Engine must be installed directly into the Switch Control
Board.
NOTE: We recommend that you install two host subsystems for redundant
protection. If you install only one host subsystem, we recommend that you
install it in slot 0.
Each host subsystem has three LEDs that display its status. The host subsystem LEDs
are located in the middle of the craft interface.
Each host subsystem has three LEDs that display its status. The host subsystem LEDs
are located in the middle of the craft interface. For more information, see “MX960 Host
Subsystem LEDs on the Craft Interface” on page 16.
If the host system is redundant, the backup Routing Engine is hot-removable and
hot-insertable, but the master Routing Engine is hot-pluggable. A Routing Engine that is
not redundant is hot-pluggable.
NOTE: If two Routing Engines are installed, they must both be the same
hardware model.
On the MX960 router, a Routing Engine installed in SCB slot 2/6 receives no power and
supplies no additional routing functions. If no SCB is installed in slot 2/6, install a blank
panel in the slot.
Related • RJ-45 Connector Pinouts for MX Series Routing Engine AUX and CONSOLE Ports on
Documentation page 141
• RJ-45 Connector Pinouts for an MX Series Routing Engine ETHERNET Port on page 140
Each Routing Engine has four LEDs that indicate its status. The LEDs, labeled MASTER,
HDD, ONLINE, and FAIL, are located directly on the faceplate of the Routing Engine.
Table 13 on page 28 describes the functions of the Routing Engine LEDs.
Table 14 on page 28 lists the current specifications for Routing Engines supported on
M Series, MX Series, and T Series routers. Table 15 on page 32 lists the hardware
specifications of the Routing Engines with VMHost support. Table 16 on page 33 lists the
specifications for end-of-life Routing Engines.
NOTE: For a list of the routing engines that are supported on the M Series,
MX Series, T Series, and PTX routers, see Supported Routing Engines by Router.
NOTE: For information about PTX Series Routing Engine specifications, see
Routing Engines Supported on PTX Series Routers.
64-bit
Junos OS
on a
standalone
T1600
router:
11.4R2
64-bit
Junos OS
on a T1600
router in a
routing
matrix:
11.4R2
NOTE: Use shielded CAT5e cable for connecting the AUX, CONSOLE, and
MGMT ports in RE-S-X6-64G, REMX2K-X8-64G, and REMX2008-X8-64G
Routing Engines.
Table 15 on page 32 lists the hardware specifications of the Routing Engines with VMHost
support.
Table 15: Hardware Specifications of the RE-MX-X6, RE-MX-X8, RE-PTX-X8, RCBPTX, RE-QFX10002-60C, and
RE-PTX10002-60C Routing Engines
Table 15: Hardware Specifications of the RE-MX-X6, RE-MX-X8, RE-PTX-X8, RCBPTX, RE-QFX10002-60C, and
RE-PTX10002-60C Routing Engines (continued)
RCBPTX PTX3000 • Wellsburg PCH-based Routing Engine with 64-GB DRAM and two
64-GB SSDs
• Multi-core Haswell CPU
On routers that accept two Routing Engines, you cannot mix Routing Engine types except
for a brief period (one minute or so) during an upgrade or downgrade to two Routing
Engines of the same type.
Interface Modules—DPCs
OK/FAIL
0/0 0/5 2/0 2/5
OK/FAIL
0/0
TUNNEL
LINK
1/0
TUNNEL
LINK
1/0 1/5
3/0 3/5
2/0
TUNNEL
LINK
3/0
TUNNEL
LINK
g004005
The DPC assembly combines packet forwarding and Ethernet interfaces on a single
board, with either two or four 10-Gbps Packet Forwarding Engines. Each Packet Forwarding
Engine consists of one I-chip for Layer 3 processing and one Layer 2 network processor.
The DPCs interface with the power supplies and Switch Control Boards (CBs).
The router has 11 dedicated DPC slots. DPCs install vertically in the front of the router
(see Figure 17 on page 37). The dedicated DPC slots are numbered 0 though 5, and 7
though 11, left to right. An additional multifunction slot labeled 2/6 supports either an
SCB or a DPC. A DPC can be installed in any slot that supports DPCs. You can install any
combination of DPC types in the router.
If a slot is not occupied by a DPC, a DPC blank panel must be installed to shield the empty
slot and to allow cooling air to circulate properly through the router.
DPCs are hot-removable and hot-insertable. When you install a DPC in an operating
router, the Routing Engine downloads the DPC software, the DPC runs its diagnostics,
and the Packet Forwarding Engines housed on the DPC are enabled. Forwarding on other
DPCs continues uninterrupted during this process.
0
MASTER
1 YELLOW ALARM
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE RED ALARM
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0
OK/FAIL
1 0
0/0 0/5
1 0
2/0 2/5
1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
DPC
1/0 1/5
3/0 3/5
g004093
DPC Components
• Fabric interfaces.
• Two Gigabit Ethernet interfaces that allow control information, route information, and
statistics to be sent between the Routing Engine and the CPU on the DPCs.
• Two interfaces from the SCBs that enable the DPCs to be powered on and controlled.
• LEDs on the DPC faceplate. For more information about LEDs on the DPC faceplate,
see the MX Series Interface Module Reference.
Two LEDs, located on the craft interface above the DPC, display the status of the DPC
and are labeled OK and FAIL.
Each DPC also has LEDs located on the faceplate. For more information about LEDs on
the DPC faceplate, see the “LEDs” section for each DPC in the MX Series Interface Module
Reference.
NOTE: These DPCs have all been announced as End of Life (EOL). The End
of Support (EOS) milestone dates for each model are published at
https://www.juniper.net/support/eol/mseries_hw.html.
Table 17 on page 38 lists the DPCs supported by the MX240, MX480, and MX960 routers.
Maximum
DPC Model Throughput First Junos
DPC Name Number Ports per DPC OS Release
Gigabit Ethernet
Gigabit Ethernet DPC with SFP DPC-R-40GE-SFP 40 40 Gbps 8.2
EOL (see
PSN-2009-06-400)
EOL (see
PSN-TSB16810)
Table 17: DPCs Supported in MX240, MX480, and MX960 Routers (continued)
Maximum
DPC Model Throughput First Junos
DPC Name Number Ports per DPC OS Release
Gigabit Ethernet Enhanced Ethernet Services DPC with SFP DPCE-X-40GE-SFP 40 40 Gbps 8.4
EOL (see
PSN-TSB16810)
Gigabit Ethernet Enhanced Queuing Ethernet Services DPC DPCE-X-Q-40GE-SFP 40 40 Gbps 8.5
with SFP
EOL (see
PSN-2013-02-851)
Gigabit Ethernet Enhanced Queuing IP Services DPCs with DPCE-R-Q-20GE-SFP 20 20 Gbps 9.1
SFP
EOL (see
PSN-2013-02-851)
Gigabit Ethernet Enhanced Queuing IP Services DPCs with DPCE-R-Q-40GE-SFP 40 40 Gbps 8.5
SFP
EOL (see
PSN-2011-07-314)
EOL (see
PSN-2009-06-400)
10-Gigabit Ethernet
10-Gigabit Ethernet Enhanced DPCs with XFP DPCE-R-2XGE-XFP 2 20 Gbps 9.1
EOL (see
PSN-2011-02-314)
EOL (see
PSN-TSB16810)
10-Gigabit Ethernet Enhanced Ethernet Services DPC with DPCE-X-4XGE-XFP 4 40 Gbps 8.4
XFP
EOL (see
PSN-TSB16810)
Table 17: DPCs Supported in MX240, MX480, and MX960 Routers (continued)
Maximum
DPC Model Throughput First Junos
DPC Name Number Ports per DPC OS Release
Mulit-Rate Ethernet
Multi-Rate Ethernet Enhanced DPC with SFP and XFP DPCE-R-20GE-2XGE 22 40 Gbps 9.2
EOL (see
PSN-TSB16810)
Multi-Rate Ethernet Enhanced Ethernet Services DPC with DPCE-X-20GE-2XGE 22 40 Gbps 9.2
SFP and XFP
EOL (see
PSN-2011-02-314)
Tri-Rate Ethernet
Tri-Rate Enhanced DPC DPCE-R-40GE-TX 40 40 Gbps 9.1
EOL (see
PSN-2013-02-851)
EOL (see
PSN-2011-07-315.)
Services
Multiservices DPC MS-DPC 2 (Not – 9.3
supported)
EOL (see
PSN-TSB16812)
See Also • Protocols and Applications Supported by DPCs and Enhanced DPCs (DPC and DPCE-R)
In the syntax of an interface name, a hyphen (-) separates the media type from the DPC
number (represented as an FPC in the CLI). The DPC slot number corresponds to the first
number in the interface. The second number in the interface corresponds to the logical
PIC number. The last number in the interface matches the port number on the DPC.
Slashes (/) separate the DPC number from the logical PIC number and port number.
type-fpc/pic/port
• so—SONET/SDH interface
• fpc—Slot in which the DPC is installed. On the MX960 router, the DPCs are represented
in the CLI as FPC 0 through FPC 11.
• pic—Logical PIC on the DPC. The number of logical PICs varies depending on the type
of DPC. For example, a:
• 20-port Gigabit Ethernet DPC has two logical PICs, numbered 0 through 1.
• 40-port Gigabit Ethernet DPC has four logical PICs, numbered 0 through 3.
• 2-port 10-Gigabit Ethernet DPC has two logical PICs, numbered 0 through 1.
• 4-port 10-Gigabit Ethernet DPC has four logical PICs, numbered 0 through 3.
For more information on specific DPCs, see “DPCs Supported on MX240, MX480, and
MX960 Routers” on page 38 in the MX Series Interface Module Reference.
• port—Port number.
The MX960 router supports up to twelve DPCs that install vertically and are numbered 0
through 11 from left to right.
Figure 18 on page 42 shows a 40-port Gigabit Ethernet DPC with SFP installed in slot 3
on the MX960 router.
MIC-3D-40GE-TX
ge-3/0/0 ge-3/0/1
ge-3/0/2 ge-3/0/3
ge-3/0/4 ge-3/0/5
ge-3/0/6 ge-3/0/7
ge-3/0/8 ge-3/0/9
ge-3/1/0 ge-3/1/1
ge-3/1/2 ge-3/1/3
ge-3/1/4 ge-3/1/5 0 1 2 3
0 1 2 3 4 5 0 1 2 6 7 8 9 10 11
ge-3/1/6 ge-3/1/7
ge-3/1/8 ge-3/1/9
ge-3/2/0 ge-3/2/1
ge-3/2/2 ge-3/2/3
ge-3/2/4 ge-3/2/5
ge-3/2/6 ge-3/2/7
ge-3/2/8 ge-3/2/9
ge-3/3/0 ge-3/3/1
ge-3/3/2 ge-3/3/3
ge-3/3/4 ge-3/3/5
ge-3/3/6 ge-3/3/7
ge-3/3/8 ge-3/3/9
g000112
The DPC contains four logical PICs, numbered PIC 0 through PIC 3 in the CLI. Each logical
PIC contains 10 ports numbered 0 through 9.
The show chassis hardware command output displays a 40-port Gigabit Ethernet DPC
with SFP (DPCE-R-40GE-SFP) installed in DPC slot 3. The DPC is shown as FPC 3 and
the DPC’s four logical PICs — 10x 1GE(LAN) — are shown as PIC 0 through PIC 3.
...
FPC 3 REV 07 750-018122 KB8222 DPCE 40x 1GE R
CPU REV 06 710-013713 KA9010 DPC PMB
PIC 0 BUILTIN BUILTIN 10x 1GE(LAN)
Xcvr 0 REV 01 740-011782 PCH2NU4 SFP-SX
Xcvr 1 REV 01 740-011782 PCH2P4R SFP-SX
Xcvr 2 REV 01 740-011782 PCH2NYL SFP-SX
Xcvr 3 REV 01 740-011782 PCH2UW6 SFP-SX
Xcvr 4 REV 01 740-011782 PCH2P4N SFP-SX
Xcvr 5 REV 01 740-011782 PCH2UME SFP-SX
Xcvr 6 REV 01 740-011613 PCE1H5P SFP-SX
Xcvr 7 REV 01 740-011782 PCH2UFG SFP-SX
Xcvr 8 REV 02 740-011613 AM0947SEYU2 SFP-SX
Xcvr 9 REV 02 740-011613 AM0947SEYTQ SFP-SX
PIC 1 BUILTIN BUILTIN 10x 1GE(LAN)
The show interfaces terse command output displays the Gigabit Ethernet interfaces that
correspond to the 40 ports located on the DPC.
ge-3/2/8 up down
ge-3/2/9 up down
ge-3/3/0 up down
ge-3/3/1 up down
ge-3/3/2 up down
ge-3/3/3 up down
ge-3/3/4 up down
ge-3/3/5 up down
ge-3/3/6 up down
ge-3/3/7 up down
ge-3/3/8 up down
ge-3/3/9 up down
See Also • MX960 Router Hardware and CLI Terminology Mapping on page 10
0
MASTER
1 YELLOW
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE ALAR
M REDALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
g004413
Figure 20 on page 46 shows the typical FPCs supported on the MX960 router.
DPCE-X-Q-40GE
DPCE-X-Q-40GE
MX-FPC2
g004417
If a slot is not occupied by a DPC, an FPC, or an SCB, a blank panel must be installed to
shield the empty slot and to allow cooling air to circulate properly through the router.
Each FPC supports up to two PICs. On an FPC2, one Packet Forwarding Engine receives
incoming packets from the PICs installed on the FPC and forwards them through the
switch planes to the appropriate destination port. On an FPC3, two Packet Forwarding
Engines receive incoming packets from the PICs installed on the FPC and forward them
through the switch planes to the appropriate destination port. The FPCs interface with
the power supplies and SCBs.
FPC Components
• Up to two Packet Forwarding Engines, each consisting of one I-chip for Layer 3
processing and one Layer 2 network processor
• Two LEDs, located on the craft interface above the FPC, that display the status of the
FPC and are labeled OK and FAIL
• FPC online/offline button, located on the craft interface above the FPC
Maximum Maximum
Number of PICs Throughput per FPC First Junos OS
FPC Type FPC Name FPC Model Number Supported (Full-duplex) Release
PICs provide the physical connection to various network media types, receiving incoming
packets from the network and transmitting outgoing packets to the network. During this
process, each PIC performs framing and line-speed signaling for its media type. Before
transmitting outgoing data packets, the PICs encapsulate the packets received from the
FPCs. Each PIC is equipped with an ASIC that performs control functions specific to the
media type of that PIC.
PICs are hot-removable and hot-insertable. Up to two PICs can be installed in the slots
in each FPC. Up to six FPCs can be installed in an MX960 router. PICs used in an FPC2
have captive screws at their upper and lower corners. PICs used in a Type 3 FPC have an
upper ejector handle and a lower captive screw.
See Also • PICs Supported by MX240, MX480, and MX960 Routers on page 50
See Also • PICs Supported by MX240, MX480, and MX960 Routers on page 50
In the syntax of an interface name, a hyphen (-) separates the media type from the FPC
slot number (represented as an FPC in the CLI). The FPC slot number corresponds to the
first number in the interface. The second number in the interface corresponds to the PIC
number. The last number in the interface matches the port number on the PIC. Slashes
(/) separate the FPC number from the PIC number and port number:
type-fpc/pic/port
• so—SONET/SDH interface
• fpc—Lowest slot number in which the FPC is installed. On the MX960 router, the FPCs
occupy two slots and are represented in the CLI as FPC 0 through FPC 10.
For more information on specific PICs, see “PICs Supported by MX240, MX480, and
MX960 Routers” on page 50 in the MX Series Interface Module Reference.
• port—Port number.
The MX960 supports up to six FPCs that install vertically and are numbered from left to
right. Each FPC accepts up to two PICs.
Figure 21 on page 49 shows a Channelized OC12/STM4 Enhanced IQ (IQE) PIC with SFP
installed in PIC slot0of an FPC installed in slot3 and slot4.
0 1 2 3
0 1 2 3 4 5 0 1 2 6 7 8 9 10 11
...
FPC 3 REV 01 710-024386 JW9571 MX FPC Type 2
The show interfaces terse command output displays the channelized SONET OC12
interfaces (coc12), that correspond to the four ports located on the PIC.
See Also • MX960 Router Hardware and CLI Terminology Mapping on page 10
PIC Name PIC Model Number Ports Type First Junos OS Release
Channelized IQ PICs
Channelized OC12/STM4 Enhanced PB-4CHOC12-STM4-IQE-SFP 4 2 9.5
IQ (IQE) PIC with SFP
SONET/SDH PICs
SONET/SDH OC3/STM1 (Multi-Rate) PB-4OC3-1OC12-SON2-SFP 4 2 9.5
PIC with SFP
Table 19: PICs Supported by MX240, MX480, and MX960 Routers (continued)
PIC Name PIC Model Number Ports Type First Junos OS Release
The AS MLC is modular and decouples CPU and storage in individual field-upgradeable
units. The AS MLCs are designed to enable application throughput up to 50 Gbps and a
storage capacity of 400 gigabytes (GB) of NAND Flash.
g006671
The AS MLC provides modular processing and modular storage. Installed on the AS MLC,
the Junos Content Encore system operates as a caching application, in either HTTP
reverse proxy mode or HTTP transparent proxy mode, to manage client requests for
content and the distribution of the content to clients from origin servers. In the future,
the AS MLC will run other Juniper Networks router services and applications, and serve
as a virtualized platform for third-party applications. The AS MLC provides Ethernet
switching and high-speed fabric interface to MX routers. Graceful Routing Engine
switchover is also supported on the AS MLC.
The AS MLC Modular Carrier Card (AS MCC), the carrier card of the AS MLC, fits vertically
in the front of the MX960 router (see Figure 23 on page 53).
0
MASTER
1 YELLOWALARM
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE REDALARM
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0
g006670
AS MLC Components
• AS MLC Modular Carrier Card (AS MCC), which fits vertically in front of the MX960
router, includes two slots for the Application Services Modular Storage Card (AS MSC)
and Application Services Modular Processing Card (AS MXC)
• XM ASIC chip, which owns and manages the packet data memory built from external
DDR3 memory chips, the fabric queuing system, a portion of the WAN queuing system,
and the host queuing system
• LU ASIC chip, which performs all functions relating to header processing including input
processing, route lookup, classification, filtering, policing, accounting, encapsulation,
and statistics
• Processor Mezzanine Board (PMB), which that contains the host processor and
supporting peripherals
MX960 SCB, Power Supply, and Cooling System Requirements for AS MLC
Each MX960 router requires specific SCB, power supply, and cooling system models to
run the AS MLC.
• Power supply:
• AS MCC—191W
• AS MXC—259W
• AS MSC—50W
• Fans:
• Fan tray—FFANTRAY-MX960-HC
Application Services Modular Storage Card (AS MSC) is a NAND Flash-based card that
is inserted into the upper slot of the Application Services Modular Line Card (AS MLC).
The AS MSC (see Figure 24 on page 55) serves as the second tier caching storage for
platforms such as the Junos Content Encore system. This card is equivalent to a PIC or
a Modular Interface Card (MIC) and provides a maximum of 3.6 Gbps read and 2 Gbps
of write memory.
AS MSCs are hot-removable and hot-insertable. One AS MSC can be installed in the top
slot of each AS MLC. Each AS MSC has these components:
• NAND Flash controller— NAND Flash and NAND Flash controller are used in an AS
MSC.
The Application Services Modular Processing Card (AS MXC) is a pluggable X86-based
card that can be inserted into the lower slot of the Application Services Modular Line
Card (AS MLC). The AS MXC serves as the processing card for the Junos Content Encore
system and contains the two X86, Intel 8-core processors with interface ability greater
than 80 Gbps. The AS MXC (see Figure 25 on page 56) is equivalent to a PIC or MIC
(Modular Interface Card).
AS MXCs are hot-removable and hot-insertable. One MXC can be installed in the lower
slot of each AS MLC. Each MXC has these components:
• Two 8-core Intel processors—Contains eight execution cores with Ring Interconnect
architecture. Each core supports two threads, up to 16 threads per socket.
• LEDs—Two LEDs on the faceplate display the CPU and application status.
g006672
See Also • MX960 Application Services Modular Storage Card Description on page 54
See Also • MX960 Application Services Modular Processing Card Description on page 55
MIC/MPC Compatibility
The following tables provide a compatibility matrix for the MICs currently supported by
MPC1, MPC2, MPC3, MPC6, MPC8, and MPC9 on MX240, MX480, MX960, MX2008,
MX2010, MX2020, and MX10003 routers. Each table lists the first Junos OS release in
which the MPC supports the MIC. For example, Junos OS Release 10.2 is the first release
in which the MX-MPC1-3D supports the Gigabit Ethernet MIC with SFP. An en dash
indicates that the MIC is not supported.
(10-Gigabit Ethernet
MICs with XFP)
MIC-3D-4XGE-XFP — — — —
(10-Gigabit Ethernet
MICs with XFP)
(Tri-Rate MIC)
(SONET/SDH
OC3/STM1
(Multi-Rate) MICs with
SFP)
(Channelized
OC3/STM1
(Multi-Rate) Circuit
Emulation MIC with
SFP)
(SONET/SDH
OC192/STM64 MIC
with XFP)
MIC-4COC3-2COC12-G,
MIC-8COC3-4COC12-G
(Channelized
SONET/SDH
OC3/STM1
(Multi-Rate) MICs with
SFP)
(DS3/E3 MIC)
(Multiservices MIC)
15.1 15.1
MIC-3D-20GE-SFP 10.1 11.2R4 14.1R4, 10.1 11.2R4 10.1 11.2R4 12.2 14.1R4,
14.2R3 14.2R3
(Gigabit Ethernet MIC with with Junos with Junos
SFP) Continuity Continuity
15.1 15.1
MIC-3D-20GE-SFP-E 13.2R2 13.2R2 14.1R4, 13.2R2 13.2R2 13.2R2 13.2R2 13.2R2 14.1R4,
14.2R3 14.2R3
(Gigabit Ethernet MIC with with Junos with Junos
SFP (E)) Continuity Continuity
15.1 15.1
MIC-3D-2XGE-XFP 10.2 11.2R4 14.1R4, 10.2 11.2R4 10.2 11.2R4 12.2 14.1R4,
14.2R3 14.2R3
(10-Gigabit Ethernet MIC with with Junos with Junos
XFP) Continuity Continuity
15.1 15.1
MIC-3D-4XGE-XFP 10.1 11.2R4 14.1R4, 10.1 11.2R4 10.1 11.2R4 12.2 14.1R4,
14.2R3 14.2R3
(10-Gigabit Ethernet MICs with Junos with Junos
with XFP) Continuity Continuity
15.1 15.1
MIC-3D-40GE-TX 10.2 11.2R4 14.1R4, 10.2 11.2R4 10.2 11.2R4 12.2 14.1R4,
14.2R3 14.2R3
(Tri-Rate MIC) with Junos with Junos
Continuity Continuity
15.1 15.1
MIC-3D-1OC192-XFP 12.2 12.2 14.1R4, 12.2 12.2 12.2 12.2 12.2 14.1R4,
14.2R3 14.2R3
(SONET/SDH OC192/STM64 with Junos with Junos
MIC with XFP) Continuity Continuity
15.1 15.1
MIC-3D-8DS3-E3, 11.4 11.4 14.1R4, 11.4 11.4 11.4 11.4 12.2 14.1R4,
MIC-3D-8CHDS3-E3-B 14.2R3 14.2R3
with Junos with Junos
(DS3/E3 MIC) Continuity Continuity
MS-MIC-16G 13.2 13.2 14.1R4, 13.2 13.2 13.2 13.2 13.2 14.1R4,
14.2R3 14.2R3
(Multiservices MIC) with Junos with Junos
Continuity Continuity
NOTE: Only one
MS-MIC-16G can be installed 15.1 15.1
into any MPC.
MIC-MACSEC-20GE Gigabit 18.3R1 18.3R1 18.3R1 18.3R1 18.3R1 18.3R1 18.3R1 18.3R1 18.3R1
Ethernet MIC with 256b-AES
MACSEC
MIC-3D-20GE-SFP 12.1 14.1R4, 14.2R3 with Junos 14.1R4, 14.2R3 with Junos
Continuity Continuity
(Gigabit Ethernet MIC with SFP)
15.1 15.1
MIC-3D-20GE-SFP-E 13.2R2 14.1R4, 14.2R3 with Junos 14.1R4, 14.2R3 with Junos
Continuity Continuity
(Gigabit Ethernet MIC with SFP (E))
15.1 15.1
MIC3-3D-1X100GE-CFP 12.1 14.1R4, 14.2R3 with Junos 14.1R4, 14.2R3 with Junos
Continuity Continuity
(100-Gigabit Ethernet MIC with CFP)
15.1 15.1
MIC-3D-2XGE-XFP 12.2 14.1R4, 14.2R3 with Junos 14.1R4, 14.2R3 with Junos
Continuity Continuity
(10-Gigabit Ethernet MICs with XFP)
15.1 15.1
MIC3-3D-10XGE-SFPP 12.3 14.1R4, 14.2 R3 and Junos 14.1R4, 14.2R3 with Junos
Continuity Continuity
(10-Gigabit Ethernet MIC with SFP+ (10 Ports))
15.1 15.1
MIC3-3D-2X40GE-QSFPP 12.2 14.1R4, 14.2R3 with Junos 14.1R4, 14.2R3 with Junos
Continuity Continuity
(40-Gigabit Ethernet MIC with QSFP+)
15.1 15.1
MIC3-3D-1X100GE-CXP 12.2 14.1R4, 14.2R3 with Junos 14.1R4, 14.2R3 with Junos
Continuity Continuity
(100-Gigabit Ethernet MIC with CXP)
15.1 15.1
MIC-3D-4OC3OC12-1OC48 13.3 14.1R4, 14.2R3 with Junos 14.1R4, 14.2R3 with Junos
Continuity Continuity
MIC-3D-8OC3OC12-4OC48
15.1 15.1
(SONET/SDH OC3/STM1 (Multi-Rate) MICs with
SFP)
MIC-3D-1OC192-XFP 13.3 14.1R4, 14.2R3 with Junos 14.1R4, 14.2R3 with Junos
Continuity Continuity
(SONET/SDH OC192/STM64 MIC with XFP)
15.1 15.1
MS-MIC-16G 13.2R2 14.1R4, 14.2R3 with Junos 14.1R4, 14.2R3 with Junos
Continuity Continuity
(Multiservices MIC)
15.1 15.1
NOTE: On MPC3E, the installation of the
Multiservices MIC (MS-MIC-16G) with
MIC3-3D-2X40GE-QSFPP, MIC3-3D-10XGE-SFPP,
or MIC3-3D-1X100GE-CFP does not meet the
NEBS criteria.
15.1 15.1
MIC-3D-4OC3OC12-1OC48, 12.1 14.1R4, 14.2R3 with Junos 14.1R4, 14.2R3 with Junos
MIC-3D-8OC3OC12-4OC48 Continuity Continuity
SONET/SDH OC3/STM1 (Multi-Rate) MICs with
SFP 15.1 15.1
MIC-3D-8DS3-E3, MIC-3D-8CHDS3-E3-B 12.1 14.1R4, 14.2R3 with Junos 14.1R4, 14.2R3 with Junos
DS3/E3 MIC Continuity Continuity
MIC6-10G 13.3R2
MIC6-10G-OTN 13.3R3
MIC6-100G-CXP 13.3R2
MIC6-100G-CFP2 13.3R3
MIC-MACSEC-MRATE 17.4
MIC-MACSEC-MRATE 17.4
JNP-MIC1 17.3
JNP-MIC1-MACSEC 17.3R2
• Junos Continuity Software User Guide (Junos OS Release 14.1R4 and Later Releases)
Modular Interface Cards (MICs) install into Modular Port Concentrators (MPCs) and
provide the physical connections to various network media types. MICs allow different
physical interfaces to be supported on a single line card. You can install MICs of different
media types on the same MPC as long as the MPC supports those MICs.
MICs receive incoming packets from the network and transmit outgoing packets to the
network. During this process, each MIC performs framing and high-speed signaling for
its media type. Before transmitting outgoing data packets through the MIC interfaces,
the MPCs encapsulate the packets received.
MICs are hot-removable and hot-insertable. You can install up to two MICs in the slots
in each MPC.
• Table 29 on page 66 lists the first supported Junos OS release for MICs on MX240,
MX480, MX960, and MX2008 routers.
• Table 30 on page 68 lists the first supported Junos OS release for MICs on MX2010
and MX2020 routers.
• Table 31 on page 70 list the first supported Junos OS release for MICs on MX5, MX10,
and MX40 routers.
• Table 32 on page 71 lists the first supported Junos OS release for MICs on MX80 and
MX104 routers.
• Table 33 on page 73 lists the first supported Junos OS release for MICs on MX10003
router.
Table 29: MICs Supported by MX240, MX480, MX960 and MX2008 Routers
MX240, MX480,
and MX960
MIC Name MIC Model Number Ports Routers MX2008 Routers
ATM
ATM MIC with SFP MIC-3D-8OC3-2OC12-ATM 8 12.1 15.1F7
DS3/E3
DS3/E3 MIC MIC-3D-8DS3-E3, 8 11.4 15.1F7
MIC-3D-8CHDS3-E3-B
Circuit Emulation
Channelized E1/T1 Circuit MIC-3D-16CHE1-T1-CE 16 12.3 15.1F7
Emulation MIC
Gigabit Ethernet
Gigabit Ethernet MIC with SFP MIC-3D-20GE-SFP 20 10.1 15.1F7
10-Gigabit Ethernet
10-Gigabit Ethernet MICs with MIC-3D-2XGE-XFP 2 10.2 15.1F7
XFP
40-Gigabit Ethernet
Table 29: MICs Supported by MX240, MX480, MX960 and MX2008 Routers (continued)
MX240, MX480,
and MX960
MIC Name MIC Model Number Ports Routers MX2008 Routers
100-Gigabit Ethernet
100-Gigabit Ethernet MIC with MIC3-3D-1X100GE-CFP 1 12.1 15.1F7
CFP
Multi-Rate
SONET/SDH OC3/STM1 MIC-3D-4OC3OC12-1OC48 4 11.2 15.1F7
(Multi-Rate) MICs with SFP
Table 29: MICs Supported by MX240, MX480, MX960 and MX2008 Routers (continued)
MX240, MX480,
and MX960
MIC Name MIC Model Number Ports Routers MX2008 Routers
Tri-Rate
Tri-Rate MIC MIC-3D-40GE-TX 40 10.2 15.1F7
Services
Multiservices MIC MS-MIC-16G 0 13.2 15.1F7
SONET/SDH
SONET/SDH OC192/STM64 MIC MIC-3D-1OC192-XFP 1 12.2 15.1F7
with XFP
MIC Name MIC Model Number Ports MX2010 Routers MX2020 Routers
ATM
ATM MIC with SFP MIC-3D-8OC3-2OC12-ATM 8 12.3 12.3
DS3/E3
DS3/E3 MIC MIC-3D-8DS3-E3, 8 12.3 12.3
MIC-3D-8CHDS3-E3-B
Circuit Emulation
Channelized E1/T1 Circuit MIC-3D-16CHE1-T1-CE 16 – –
Emulation MIC
Gigabit Ethernet
Gigabit Ethernet MIC with SFP MIC-3D-20GE-SFP 20 12.3 12.3
10-Gigabit Ethernet
10-Gigabit Ethernet MICs with MIC-3D-2XGE-XFP 2 12.3 12.3
XFP
MIC Name MIC Model Number Ports MX2010 Routers MX2020 Routers
40-Gigabit Ethernet
40-Gigabit Ethernet MIC with MIC3-3D-2X40GE-QSFPP 2 12.3 12.3
QSFP+
100-Gigabit Ethernet
100-Gigabit Ethernet MIC with MIC3-3D-1X100GE-CFP 1 12.3 12.3
CFP
Multi-Rate
SONET/SDH OC3/STM1 MIC-3D-4OC3OC12-1OC48 4 12.3 12.3
(Multi-Rate) MICs with SFP
MIC MRATE (12-Port Multi-Rate MIC-MRATE 12 • 15.1F5 with Junos • 15.1F5 with Junos
MIC with QSFP+) Continuity Continuity
• 16.1R1 and later • 16.1R1 and later
MIC Name MIC Model Number Ports MX2010 Routers MX2020 Routers
Tri-Rate
Tri-Rate MIC MIC-3D-40GE-TX 40 12.3 12.3
Services
Multiservices MIC MS-MIC-16G 0 13.2 13.2
SONET/SDH
SONET/SDH OC192/STM64 MIC MIC-3D-1OC192-XFP 1 12.3 12.3
with XFP
ATM
ATM MIC with SFP MIC-3D-8OC3-2OC12-ATM 8 12.1 12.1 12.1
DS3/E3
DS3/E3 MIC MIC-3D-8DS3-E3, 8 11.4 11.4 11.4
MIC-3D-8CHDS3-E3-B
Circuit Emulation
Channelized E1/T1 Circuit MIC-3D-16CHE1-T1-CE 16 13.2R2 13.2R2 13.2R2
Emulation MIC
Gigabit Ethernet
Gigabit Ethernet MIC with SFP MIC-3D-20GE-SFP 20 11.2R4 11.2R4 11.2R4
10-Gigabit Ethernet
10-Gigabit Ethernet MICs with MIC-3D-2XGE-XFP 2 11.2R4 11.2R4 11.2R4
XFP
Table 31: MICs Supported by MX5, MX10, and MX40 Routers (continued)
Multi-Rate
SONET/SDH OC3/STM1 MIC-3D-4OC3OC12-1OC48 4 11.2R4 11.2R4 11.2R4
(Multi-Rate) MICs with SFP
Tri-Rate
Tri-Rate MIC MIC-3D-40GE-TX 40 – 11.2R4 11.2R4
Services
Multiservices MIC MS-MIC-16G 0 13.2 13.2 13.2
ATM
ATM MIC with SFP MIC-3D-8OC3-2OC12-ATM 8 12.1 13.3
DS3/E3
DS3/E3 MIC MIC-3D-8DS3-E3, 8 11.4 13.3
MIC-3D-8CHDS3-E3-B
Circuit Emulation
Gigabit Ethernet
Gigabit Ethernet MIC with SFP MIC-3D-20GE-SFP 20 10.2 13.2R2
Multi-Rate
SONET/SDH OC3/STM1 MIC-3D-4OC3OC12-1OC48 4 11.2 13.3
(Multi-Rate) MICs with SFP
Tri-Rate
Tri-Rate MIC MIC-3D-40GE-TX 40 10.2 13.2R2
Services
SONET/SDH
SONET/SDH OC192/STM64 MIC MIC-3D-1OC192-XFP 1 12.2 13.3
with XFP
Multi-Rate
Multi-Rate Ethernet MIC (12-Port JNP-MIC1 12 17.3
Multi-Rate MIC with QSFP+)
NOTE: Fixed configuration MPCs, that is, MPCs with built-in MICs follow the
port numbering of DPCs.
In the syntax of an interface name, a hyphen (-) separates the media type from the MPC
number (represented as an FPC in the CLI). The MPC slot number corresponds to the
first number in the interface. The second number in the interface corresponds to the
logical PIC number. The last number in the interface matches the port number on the
MIC. Slashes (/) separate the MPC number from the logical PIC number and port number:
type-fpc/pic/port
• so—SONET/SDH interface
• fpc—Slot in which the MPC is installed. On the MX960 router, the MPCs are represented
in the CLI as FPC 0 through FPC 11.
• pic—Logical PIC on the MIC, numbered 0 or 1 when installed in MIC slot 0 and 2 or 3
when installed in MIC slot 1. The number of logical PICs varies depending on the type
of MIC. For example, a:
• 20-port Gigabit Ethernet MIC has two logical PICs, numbered 0 and 1 when installed
in MIC slot 0, or 2 and 3 when installed in MIC slot 1.
• 4-port 10-Gigabit Ethernet MIC has two logical PICs numbered 0 and 1 when installed
in MIC slot 0, or 2 and 3 when installed in MIC slot 1.
• 100-Gigabit Ethernet MIC with CFP has one logical PIC numbered 0 when installed
in MIC slot 0 or 2 when installed in MIC slot 1.
For more information on specific MICs, see “MICs Supported by MX Series Routers” on
page 65 in the MX Series Interface Module Reference.
• port—Port number.
The MX960 supports up to twelve MPCs that install vertically and are numbered from
left to right. Each MPC accepts up to two MICs.
Figure 26 on page 75 shows an example of a 20-port Gigabit Ethernet MIC with SFP
installed in MIC slot 0 of an MPC in slot 3.
NOTE: The 20-port Gigabit Ethernet MIC with SFP-E has a different port
numbering. See Gigabit Ethernet MIC with SFP (E)
Figure 26: Port Mapping for the 20-Port Gigabit Ethernet MIC with SFP Installed in the
MX960
0 1 2 3
0 1 2 3 4 5 0 1 2 6 7 8 9 10 11
The MIC contains two logical PICs, numbered PIC 0 through PIC 1 in the CLI. Each logical
PIC contains 10 ports numbered 0 through 9.
The show chassis hardware command output displays a 20-port Gigabit Ethernet MIC
with SFP — 3D 20x 1GE(LAN) SFP — installed in MIC slot 0 of an MPC (MPC Type 2 3D
EQ) in slot 3. The MPC is shown as FPC 3 and the MIC’s two logical PICs — 10x 1GE(LAN)
SFP — are shown as PIC 0 and PIC 1.
...
FPC 3 REV 28 750-031090 YH8181 MPC Type 2 3D EQ
CPU REV 06 711-030884 YH9437 MPC PMB 2G
MIC 0 REV 22 750-028392 YD0439 3D 20x 1GE(LAN) SFP
PIC 0 BUILTIN BUILTIN 10x 1GE(LAN) SFP
Xcvr 0 REV 01 740-011613 PCE14D5 SFP-SX
Xcvr 1 REV 01 740-011782 P9C280T SFP-SX
Xcvr 2 REV 01 740-011782 P9C2512 SFP-SX
Xcvr 3 REV 02 740-011613 AM0951SFF3Z SFP-SX
Xcvr 4 REV 02 740-011613 AM0951SFF33 SFP-SX
Xcvr 5 REV 02 740-011613 AM0951SFF3Y SFP-SX
Xcvr 6 REV 02 740-011613 AM0951SFF4B SFP-SX
The show interfaces terse command output displays the Gigabit Ethernet interfaces that
correspond to the 20 ports located on the MIC.
See Also • MX960 Router Hardware and CLI Terminology Mapping on page 10
A specialized fixed configuration MPC provides higher port density over MICs and combines
packet forwarding and Ethernet interfaces onto a single line card. The fixed configuration
MPC is inserted into a slot in a router and contains no slots for MICs.
MICs receive incoming packets from the network and transmit outgoing packets to the
network. During this process, each MIC performs framing and high-speed signaling for
its media type. Before transmitting outgoing data packets through the MIC interfaces,
the MPCs encapsulate the packets received. Each MPC is equipped with up to four Junos
Trio chipsets, which perform control functions tailored to the MPC’s media type. The
MPCs interface with the power supplies and Switch Control Boards (SCBs). You must
install redundant SCBs to support full line rate.
The MX960 router supports up to 12 MPCs. You must install a high-capacity fan tray to
use an MPC. For power requirements, see “Calculating Power Requirements for MX960
Routers” on page 152.
The router has 11 dedicated line-card slots for DPCs, MPCs, or FPCs. MPCs install vertically
in the front of the router. The dedicated slots are numbered 0 though 5, and 7 though 11,
left to right. An additional multifunction slot labeled 2/6 supports either an SCB, a DPC,
an FPC, or an MPC. An MPC can be installed in any slot that supports MPCs. You can
install any combination of MPC types in the router.
When a slot is not occupied by an MPC or other line card, you must insert a blank DPC
panel to fill the empty slot and ensure proper cooling of the system.
MPCs are hot-removable and hot-insertable. When you install an MPC in an operating
router, the Routing Engine downloads the MPC software, the MPC runs its diagnostics,
and the Packet Forwarding Engines housed on the MPC are enabled. Forwarding on other
MPCs continues uninterrupted during this process.
MPC (empty)
g004902
0
MASTER
1 YELLOW ALARM
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE RED ALARM
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0
MPC 1 0 1 0 1
0
g004908
MPC Components
• MPC card carrier, which includes two MIC slots (excludes the fixed configuration MPC).
• Fabric interfaces.
• Two Gigabit Ethernet interfaces that allow control information, route information, and
statistics to be sent between the Routing Engine and the CPU on the MPCs.
• Two interfaces from the SCBs that enable the MPCs to be powered on and controlled.
• Up to four Junos Trio chipsets, which perform control functions tailored to the MPC’s
media type.
• Online button which takes the MPC online or offline when pressed.
• OK/Fail LED on the MPC faceplate. For more information about LEDs on the MPC
faceplate, see the MX Series Interface Module Reference.
Two LEDs, located on the craft interface above the MPC, display the status of the line
cards and are labeled OK and FAIL.
Each MPC also has LEDs located on the faceplate. For more information about LEDs on
the MPC faceplate, see the “LEDs” section for each MPC in the MX Series Interface Module
Reference.
Table 34: MPCs Supported by MX240, MX480, MX960, MX2008, MX2010, MX2020, and MX10003 Routers
First
Junos OS
Release
on First First First
MX240, Junos OS First Junos First Junos Junos OS Junos OS
MX480, Release OS OS Release Release
and on Release on Release on on on
MX960 MX2008 MX2010 MX2020 MX10003 MX10008
MPC Name MPC Model Number Routers Routers Routers Routers Routers Routers
16XGE-SFP
32XGE-SFPP
Table 34: MPCs Supported by MX240, MX480, MX960, MX2008, MX2010, MX2020, and MX10003
Routers (continued)
First
Junos OS
Release
on First First First
MX240, Junos OS First Junos First Junos Junos OS Junos OS
MX480, Release OS OS Release Release
and on Release on Release on on on
MX960 MX2008 MX2010 MX2020 MX10003 MX10008
MPC Name MPC Model Number Routers Routers Routers Routers Routers Routers
MPCs
MPC1 MX-MPC1-3D 10.2 15.1F7 12.3 12.3 – –
Table 34: MPCs Supported by MX240, MX480, MX960, MX2008, MX2010, MX2020, and MX10003
Routers (continued)
First
Junos OS
Release
on First First First
MX240, Junos OS First Junos First Junos Junos OS Junos OS
MX480, Release OS OS Release Release
and on Release on Release on on on
MX960 MX2008 MX2010 MX2020 MX10003 MX10008
MPC Name MPC Model Number Routers Routers Routers Routers Routers Routers
The MX960 router uses either AC or DC power supplies. The MX960 router is configurable
with three or four normal-capacity AC power supplies, up to four high-capacity DC power
supplies, and up to four high-capacity AC power supplies. The power supplies connect
to the midplane, which distributes the different output voltages produced by the power
supplies to the router components, depending on their voltage requirements.
All power supplies are hot-removable and hot-insertable. Each power supply is cooled
by its own internal cooling system.
Unlike systems with previous MX960 AC supplies, the systems with MX Series
high-capacity power supplies are zoned. No current sharing between power supplies is
needed with the upgraded system because the redundancy changes from 3+1 per system
to 1+1 per zone. For MX960 AC configurations, two zones are present. Two adjacent
power supplies need to be installed in the chassis with two feeds attached.
NOTE: Two AC power cables are required when installing the high-capacity
AC power supplies.
NOTE: Routers configured with DC power supplies are shipped with a blank
panel installed over the power distribution modules. Routers configured with
AC power supplies have no blank panel.
The MX960 requires special power supplies that are not interchangeable with the MX240,
MX480, or the MX2000 series routers. Two types of AC power supplies can be used:
normal-capacity or high-capacity. Each AC power supply has a corresponding AC
appliance inlet located in the MX960 chassis directly above the power supply. Additionally,
high-capacity AC power supplies have an AC appliance inlet on the power supply itself.
Each inlet requires a dedicated AC power feed and a dedicated 15 A (250 VAC) circuit
breaker for the normal-capacity power supply and 38 A (264 VAC) circuit breaker for
the high-capacity power supply. One power cord per feed is required. See “AC Power
Cord Specifications for the MX960 Router” on page 156 for more details.
Air exhaust
Input mode
switch
AC Power
supplies
g017591
Power supply
ejectors
The minimum number of power supplies must be present in the router at all times. Refer
to Table 35 on page 87.
Table 35: Minimum Number of Power Supplies Required for the MX960
Table 35: Minimum Number of Power Supplies Required for the MX960 (continued)
In one-feed mode, the power supplies output power at a reduced capacity (1700W). In
two-feed mode, the power supplies provide power at full capacity (4100W). To operate
the MX960 at full capacity, you must use two-feed mode. High-capacity power supplies
require one power cord per feed. Therefore, to operate the MX960 at full capacity, you
will need four power cords.
Each high-capacity AC power supply accepts two AC feeds in two unique AC receptacles,
one receptacle located on the chassis and the other on the power supply.
When using the high-capacity AC power supplies in one-feed mode, plug one end of the
power cord into the corresponding AC receptacle directly above the power supply in the
chassis and the other end into a AC outlet. When using the high-capacity power supply
in two-feed mode, you need two power cords. Plug one power cord into the AC receptacle
on the chassis and then plug the other end into a AC outlet. Next, plug the second power
cord into the AC receptacle on the AC power supply and plug the other end into a AC
outlet.
In high-capacity AC power supply configurations, there are two zones that provide power
to specific components in the MX system. No current sharing between power supplies
is needed with the high-capacity system because the redundancy changes from 3+1 per
system to 1+1 per zone.Table 36 on page 89 lists the components that receive power for
each zone in a high-capacity AC power supply configuration.
Chassis Power Configuration Zone Power Supply (PEM) Components Receiving Power
1
0 1
0
g006057
Use the show chassis power command to verify that the DIP switch settings on the
high-capacity AC power supplies are set to the correct position. Here are examples of
the command output:
PEM 0:
State: Online
AC input: OK (2 feed expected, 2 feed connected)
Capacity: 4100 W (maximum 4100 W)
DC output: 855 W (zone 0, 15 A at 57 V, 20% of capacity)
PEM 1:
State: Online
AC input: OK (1 feed expected, 1 feed connected)
Capacity: 1700 W (maximum 4100 W)
DC output: 969 W (zone 1, 17 A at 57 V, 57% of capacity)
In Example 1, PEM 0 is running at full capacity (4100 W) with two AC feeds expected and
two AC feeds connected. This indicates that the DIP switch is properly set to Position 1
since two AC feeds are connected. The example also shows that PEM 1 is running at
reduced capacity (1700W) with one AC feed expected and one AC feed connected. This
indicates that the DIP switch is correctly set to Position 0 since one feed is present.
Example 2 shows the show chassis power command output when the DIP switch is set
improperly:
PEM 0:
State: Online
AC input: OK (2 feed expected, 2 feed connected)
Capacity: 4100 W (maximum 4100 W)
DC output: 0 W (zone 0, 0 A at 56 V, 0% of capacity)
PEM 1:
State: Present
AC input: Check (2 feed expected, 1 feed connected)
Capacity: 1700 W (maximum 4100 W)
The PEM 0 status indicates the system is Online, the AC Input is OK, is running at full
capacity (4100 W) with two AC feeds expected and two AC feeds connected. But notice
the status for PEM 1. The State is Present and the AC input is Check (2 feed expected, 1
feed connected). This indicates there is a mismatch between the DIP switch setting and
the number of feeds connected. Therefore, the power supply is running at reduced capacity
(1700 W). If PEM 1 should be running at full-capacity, verify that there are two feeds
connected to the power supplies and the DIP switch is set to position 1.
• AC Power Circuit Breaker Requirements for the MX960 Router on page 156
Each AC power supply faceplate contains three LEDs that indicate the status of the
power supply (see Table 37 on page 91). The power supply status is also reflected in two
LEDs on the craft interface In addition, a power supply failure triggers the red alarm LED
on the craft interface.
AC OK Green Off AC power applied to power supply is not within the normal operating range.
DC OK Green Off DC power outputs generated by the power supply are not within the normal
operating ranges.
On DC power outputs generated by the power supply are within the normal operating
ranges.
On Power supply is not functioning normally. Check AC OK and DC OK LEDs for more
information.
In the DC power configuration, the router contains either two or four DC power supplies
(see Figure 32 on page 92), located at the lower rear of the chassis in slots PEM0
through PEM3 (left to right). You can upgrade your DC power system from two to four
power supplies. The DC power supplies in slots PEM0 and PEM2 provide power to the
lower fan tray, DPC slots 6 through 11, and SCB slots 1 and 2. The DC power supplies in
slots PEM1 and PEM3 provide power to the upper fan tray, DPC slots 0 through 5, and
SCB slot 0.
Four power supplies provide full redundancy. If a DC power supply fails, its redundant
power supply takes over without interruption.
For existing power supplies, each DC power supply has a single DC input (–48 VDC and
return). For high-capacity power supplies, each DC power supply has two DC inputs (–48
VDC and return).
The minimum number of power supplies must be present in the router at all times. See
Table 38 on page 92 for the minimum required number of power supplies.
Each high-capacity DC power supply supports two DC feeds. You must set the input
mode switch according to the number of DC feeds available for the power entry
module(PEM). The input mode switch positions 0 and 1 indicate the following:
• DC Power Circuit Breaker Requirements for the MX960 Router on page 173
Each DC power supply faceplate contains three LEDs that indicate the status of the
power supply (see Table 39 on page 94). The power supply status is also reflected in
two LEDs on the craft interface. In addition, a power supply failure triggers the red alarm
LED on the craft interface.
PWR OK Green Off Power supply is not functioning normally. Check the INPUT OK LED for more
information.
At the heart of the MX Series 5G Universal Routing Platform is the Switch and Control
Board (SCB). The SCB has three primary functions: switch data between the line cards,
control the chassis, and house the Routing Engine. The SCB is a single-slot card and has
a carrier for the Routing Engine on the front.
Switch Control Boards control power to MPCs, monitor and control system functions
such as fan speed and the system front panel, and manage clocking, resets, and boots.
Depending on the MX chassis and the level of redundancy, the number of SCBs can vary.
The MX240 and MX480 require two SCBs for 1+1 redundancy, whereas the MX960
requires three SCBs for 2+1 redundancy.
There are four generations of SCBs for the MX Series 5G Universal Routing Platform:
SCB-MX, SCBE-MX, SCBE2-MX, and SCBE3-MX.
• SCB-MX is the first-generation switch control board. The SCB-MX is designed to work
with first-generation DPC line cards.
• The SCBE-MX is the second generation switch control board and is designed specifically
for use with MPC3E line cards to provide full line-rate performance and redundancy
without a loss of bandwidth.
• The SCBE2-MX provides improved fabric performance for high-capacity line cards
using the third generation fabric XF2 chip (MPC4E, MPC5E, MPC2/3 NG, and MPC7E).
• The SCBE3-MX Enhanced Switch Control Board provides improved fabric performance
and bandwidth capabilities for high-capacity line cards using the ZF-based switch
fabric.
Table 4 on page 4 compares the SCB capacities of the MX Series 5G Universal Routing
Platforms.
Table 40: Switch Control Board Capacities for MX Series 5G Universal Routing Platforms (Full-Duplex)
Enhanced MX Switch Up to 480 Gbps (non-redundant Up to 1.92 Tbps Up to 5.76 Tbps Up to 10.56 Tbps
Control Board fabric configuration); 340 Gbps
(SCBE2-MX) (redundant fabric configuration)
Enhanced MX Switch Up to 240 Gbps (non-redundant Up to 930 Gbps Up to 2.79 Tbps Up to 5.25 Tbps
Control Board fabric configuration); 160 Gbps
(SCBE-MX) (redundant fabric configuration)
Switch Control Board Up to 240 Gbps (non-redundant Up to 465 Gbps Up to 1.39 Tbps Up to 2.6 Tbps
(SCB-MX) fabric configuration); 120 Gbps
(redundant fabric configuration)
Table 41: Supported Routing Engines for MX Series 5G Universal Routing Platforms Switch Control Boards
SCBE3-MX RE-S-1800x2
RE-S-1800x4
RE-S-X6-64G
RE-S-X6-128G
RE-S-X6-64G-LT
RE-S-2000 (EOLed)
RE-S-1800*
RE-S-X6*
RE-S-2000 (EOLed)
RE-S-1800*
Table 41: Supported Routing Engines for MX Series 5G Universal Routing Platforms Switch Control
Boards (continued)
RE-S-2000 (EOLed)
RE-S-1800
* All variants
CLI Identification
The SCBs are identified in the CLI as:
SCB-MX MX SCB
SCBE2-MX SCBE2-MX-S
SCBE3-MX SCBE3-MX-S
SCBE3-MX Description
The SCBE3-MX Enhanced Switch Control Board provides improved fabric performance
and bandwidth capabilities for high-capacity line cards using the ZF-based switch fabric.
In a redundant configuration, the SCBE3-MX provides fabric bandwidth of up to 1 Tbps
per slot. In a non-redundant configuration the SCBE3-MX provides fabric bandwidth of
up to 1 Tbps per slot (four fabric planes) and 1.5 Tbps per slot fabric bandwidth when all
six fabric planes are used (with MPC10E line cards). The SCBE3-MX is supported on Junos
18.4R1 and later releases. It is installed vertically into the MX960 chassis, and horizontally
in the MX480 and MX240 chassis.
SCBE3-MX
g100332
SCBE3 LEDs OK/FAIL—A green LED indicates the board is OK. A red LED indicates the board has failed.
FABRIC ACTIVE—A green LED indicates the switch fabric on this board is in Active mode.
FABRIC ONLY—A green LED indicates the switch is in fabric-only mode and on slot 8.
GPS EXT CLK—Indicates the status of the GPS clocking interface. If the LED is green, the link
is OK. If the LED is blinking amber, there is activity on the clocking interface.
Shipping box:
SCBE3-MX Power and Cooling For efficient and reliable power and cooling, you must install MX-series high-capacity power
Requirements supplies and fan trays in the MX chassis. Additionally, for the MX960, you must install a
high-capacity filter tray.
NOTE: If you are using old fan trays and the internal temperature of the chassis exceeds 25°
C, the chassis may overheat and a shutdown may occur.
Component/Feature Description
XGE ports Two Ethernet ports provide 10 GE/1 GE SFP+ interfaces. These ports also are connected to the
Ethernet control switch which limits the traffic for the 10 GE port and provides security to prevent
unwanted access to the control plane via the external ports.
GPS port One RJ-45 GPS external clock interface port receives GPS and PPS timing from the GPS external
interface. A red LED indicates there is no clock present or the clock is not OK. A green LED
indicates the clock interface is active and OK. If the LED is off, the clock interface is not enabled.
External clock interface The external clock interface is on the SCBE3-MX front panel. The clock source interface receives
GPS and PPS timing from the GPS external interface.
Component/Feature Description
Centralized Stratum3E clock The clock module performs clock monitoring, filtering, and holdover on the centralized fabric
module card. This centralized clocking architecture also provides clock cleanup and distribution.
In-system removable Routing The in-system Routing Engine can support any new Routing Engine that conforms to the
Engine standard modular Routing Engine I/O interface and form factor.
NOTE: When a Routing Engine is not installed in the SCBE3-MX, you need to cover the empty
slot with a blank panel.
Hot-Swappable The SCBE3-MX and associated Routing Engine assembly are hot-swappable. The system
software provides a mechanism to shut down, or acquiesce the Routing Engine/SCBE3-MX.
The system software also provides a method to reset or reboot the Routing Engine/SCBE3-MX.
This support is provided via cli commands, and various hardware support circuits.
NOTE: The Routing Engine must be brought offline prior to removal to avoid possible corruption
of the hard drive.
System upgrade capabilities See “Upgrading an MX240, MX480, or MX960 Router to Use the SCBE3-MX” on page 435for
details.
Redundancy With three SCBE3-MX’s installed, the MX960 router provides 2 + 1 redundancy. With two
SCBE3-MX’s installed, the MX240 router and MX480 router provide 1 + 1 redundancy.
MPC line cards Supports the MPCs listed in Table 42 on page 102.
Hitless Operation Allows you to upgrade programmable parts and reboot with “hitless” operation if the redundant
SCBE3-MX’s are inserted in the system and are operational.
Removable Routing Engine You can remove the Routing Engine module FRU in the existing form factor.
Module
• The MX960 system may contain up to three SCBE3-MX’s to provide a total of six switch
fabric planes for packet forwarding among the MPCs. Two fabric planes per SCBE3-MX’s
are required. To achieve full fabric bandwidth performance, three SCBE3-MX’s must
be installed in the MX960 chassis.
• Two chassis slots are provided in the center of the MX960 chassis in slots 6 and 7 (also
designated as slot SCB 0 and slot SCB 1) for two SCBE3-MXs, each equipped with a
Routing Engine.
• Slot 8 in the MX960 chassis is a dual-purpose slot, and supports either an SCBE3-MX
or an MPC. When the SCBE3-MX/Routing Engine are plugged into slot 8, the Routing
Engine is powered down and does not provide any control functionality for the board
or the MX960. The fabric-only LED on the card faceplate will be lit when an
SCBE3-MX/Routing Engine assembly is plugged into slot 8.
• In a non-redundant configuration, all six fabric planes will be in Active mode for
increased fabric bandwidth.
• There is one ZF-based switch fabric per SCBE3-MX and it acts as two virtual planes
in MX960.
• You can install either one or two SCBE3-MX’s in the MX480 and MX240 router chassis
in the slots labeled 0 and 1.
• The SCBE3-MX in slot 0 (SCB 0) provides two fabric planes; the SCBE3-MX in slot 1
(SCB 1) provides four fabric planes. A total of six fabric planes are available in the
MX240 and MX480 routers.
• In redundant configuration, two fabric planes on the first SCBE3-MX and two fabric
planes on the other SCBE3-MX will be in Active mode.
• There is one ZF-based switch fabric per SCBE3-MX and it acts as four virtual planes
in the MX480 and MX240.
Two SCBE3-MX’s installed in the MX240 or MX480 are required for 1 + 1 redundancy.
To provide 1 + 1 fabric redundancy, there must be an SCBE3-MX installed in slot 1.
NOTE:
• If SCB 0 fails, SCB 1 will be automatically configured with four fabric
planes active. In this fail over scenario, the SCBE3-MX will support full
line rate 100% redundancy.
• If SCB 1 fails, SCB 0 has only two available fabric planes; therefore, in
this failover mode, the line rate will drop to 50%.
NOTE: These power consumption values are for the SCBE3-MX only. They
do not include re-allocated power.
40°C 400W
25C° 385W
40°C 280W
25C° 265W
40°C 400W
25C° 385W
40°C 260W
25C° 245W
40°C 280W
25C° 265W
SCBE3-MX Operating
Mode MX240/480/960 Supported
DPC/MS-DPC No
Table 42: SCBE3 Interoperabilitiy with MPCs and Routing Engines (continued)
SCBE3-MX Operating
Mode MX240/480/960 Supported
MPC2E No
MPC2E-NG Yes
MPC3E Yes
MPC3E-NG Yes
MPC4E Yes
16x10GE MPC No
MPC5E Yes
MPC6E No
RE-S-2000 (EOLed) no
• The SCBE3-MX does not interoperate with any previous generation SCBs (SCB, SCBE,
and SCBE2). Smooth upgrade is not supported.
• The SCBE3-MX does not support the MPC1/2 NEO line card or legacy I-chip based line
cards.
• Due to certain limitations in functionality, the MPC7E is not supported in slot 1 when
the SCBE3-MX is plugged in to an MX960 PREMIUM3/BASE3 system. If you have an
MPC7E in slot 1, move it to a different slot before installing the SCBE3-MX.
Related • Upgrading an MX240, MX480, or MX960 Router to Use the SCBE3-MX on page 435
Documentation
SCBE2-MX Description
The MX Enhanced Switch Control Board (SCBE2-MX) serves the carrier Ethernet services
router and carrier Ethernet transport markets that require higher-capacity traffic support,
demanding greater interface density (slot and capacity scale) as well as improved
services. The SCBE-MX is supported on MX960, MX480, and MX240 routers.
The SCBE2-MX is installed vertically in the MX960 chassis and horizontally in the MX480
and MX240 chassis. The routing engine is installed directly into a slot on the SCBE2-MX
(see Figure 35 on page 105).
Requirements For proper cooling, you must install MX-series high-capacity fan trays in the MX chassis.
Additionally, for the MX960, you must install a high-capacity filter tray.
SCBE2-MX Features • Provides improved fabric performance for high-capacity line cards using the third generation
fabric XF2 chip.
• Provides bandwidth of up to 340 Gbps per slot with redundant fabric support and 480 Gbps
per slot without redundant fabric support.
• Provides a central clocking module and a centralized clocking architecture that supports clock
cleanup and distribution. The Stratum 3 clock module performs clock monitoring, filtering, and
holdover at a centralized chassis location.
• Supports dynamic multicast replication.
• Supports GRES.
• Supports MPC line cards. Does not support DPCs.
• Allows you to configure the system such that one SCBE2-MX supports a GPS interface, and
the other SCBE2-MX supports a BITS interface.
• Provides support for cross-coupling of clock input. This requires an enhanced midplane:
• MX960—CHAS-BP3-MX960-S
• MX480—CHAS-BP3-MX480-S
• MX240—CHAS-BP3-MX240-S
SCBE2-MX Components • Control Board and Routing Engine (CB-RE) mastership mechanism.
• External clock interface—Allows BITS or GPS clock source input to the centralized timing circuit,
or allows centralized timing to be output to BITS or GPS.
• Switch fabric—Provides switching functions for MPCs.
• 1000Base-T Ethernet controller—Provides a 1 Gbps Ethernet link between the Routing Engines.
• Power circuits for the Routing Engine and the SCBE2-MX.
• LEDs—Provide status of the SCBE2-MX and the clocking interface.
• You can install either one or two SCBE2-MX’s in the MX480 and MX240 router chassis.
SCBE2-MX’s are installed horizontally into the front of the MX480 and MX240 chassis in the
slots labeled 0 and 1. If any slots are empty, you must install a blank panel.
• Each SCBE2-MX provides four switch fabric planes for packet forwarding among the MPCs in
the MX480 and MX240 chassis.
• The MX480 and MX240 routers contain a maximum of two SCBE2-MX’s. Therefore, eight
logical planes are available.
• Two SCBE2-MX’s are required for 1 + 1 redundancy.
• In redundant fabric mode, four fabric planes from the first SCBE2-MX will be in Active mode,
and four fabric planes from the second SCBE2-MX will be in Spare mode.
• In a non-redundant fabric mode, all eight fabric planes will be in Active mode to provide increased
fabric bandwidth.
• Each fabric ASIC is configured in virtual plane mode, where two virtual planes exist on one
fabric ASIC.
Weight and Dimensions • Weight: 9.6 lb (4.4 kg) (with Routing Engine installed)
• Width: 17 in (43.2 cm)
• Depth: 22 in (55.9 cm)
• Height: 1.25 in (3.2 cm) height.
160 W at 40° C
155 W at 25° C
LEDs • FABRIC ACTIVE, FABRIC ONLY, and OK/FAIL LEDs indicate the status of the SCBE2-MX.
• The BITS, GPS, and UTI LEDs, located next to the EXT CLK port, indicate the status of the
respective clocking interface.
• The LINK LED located next to the two Ethernet ports, indicate the status of the respective SFP+
interface.
For more information about the SCBE2-MX LEDs, see SCBE2-MX LEDs.
MPC1 Yes
MPC2 Yes
MPC3 Yes
MPC4 Yes
MPC2-NG Yes
MPC3-NG Yes
MPC5 Yes
MPC6 No
SCBE2-MX LEDs
FABRIC ACTIVE, FABRIC ONLY, and OK/FAIL LEDs indicate the status of the SCBE2-MX.
The BITS, GPS, and UTI LEDs, located next to the EXT CLK port, indicate the status of the
respective clocking interface. The LINK LED located next to the two Ethernet ports,
indicate the status of the respective SFP+ interface. Table 43 on page 108 describes the
functions of the SCBE2-MX LEDs.
SCBE-MX Description
The MX Enhanced Switch Control Board (SCBE-MX) for MX960, MX480, and MX240
routers serves the carrier Ethernet services router and carrier Ethernet transport markets
that require higher-capacity traffic support, demanding greater interface density (slot
and capacity scale), as well as improved services. The SCBE-MX provides:
• 160 Gbps/slot bandwidth with redundant fabric support, and improved fabric
performance by using the next-generation fabric (XF) chip
• A central clocking module and a centralized clocking architecture that supports clock
cleanup and distribution. The Stratum 3 clock module performs clock monitoring,
filtering, and holdover in a centralized chassis location
• Full performance with fabric redundancy for higher capacity line cards such as 16x10GE
and MPC3
The Routing Engine installs directly into a slot on the SCBE-MX (see Figure 36 on page 110).
SCBE-MX
g006589
Table 44 on page 110 lists the maximum number of SCBE-MXs you can install in the MX
chassis, the corresponding slot labels, and the backup slot used for redundancy. If any
slots are empty, you must install a blank panel.
MX960 3 0, 1, and 2 2
MX480 2 0 and 1 1
MX240 2 0 and 1 1
Table 45: Supported Routing Engines and MPCs for the SCBE-MX
RE-S-1300 MPC3e
RE-S-2000 MPC3e
SCBE-MX LEDs
The FABRIC ACTIVE, FABRIC ONLY, and OK/FAIL LEDs indicate the status of the SCBE-MX.
The BITS, GPS, and UTI LEDs (next to the EXT CLK port) indicate the status of the
respective clocking interface. Table 46 on page 111 describes the behavior of the SCBE-MX
LEDs.
NOTE: The LEDs BITS, GPS, and UTI are not currently supported.
SCB-MX Description
The MX Switch Control Board (SCB-MX) provides control plane functions, chassis
management functions, and switch plane functions for MX960, MX480, and MX240
routers. It is also a carrier for the Routing Engine which installs directly into a slot on the
SCB-MX. See Figure 37 on page 112.
SCB-MX Functions • Powers on and powers off DPCs, FPCs, and MPCs.
• Controls clocking, system resets, and booting.
• Monitors and controls system functions, including fan speed, board power status, power
distribution module status and control, and the craft interface
• Provides Ethernet connectivity to all processors in the chassis for control plane communications.
• Provides bandwidth of up to 160 Gbps per slot with redundant fabric support.
• Provides interconnections to all the DPCs, FPCs, and MPCs within the chassis through the
switch fabrics integrated into the SCB-MX.
SCB-MX Components • Control Board and Routing Engine (CB-RE) mastership mechanism.
• External clock interface—Allows BITS or GPS clock source input to the centralized timing circuit,
or allows centralized timing to be output to BITS or GPS.
• Switch fabric—Provides switching functions for MPCs.
• 1000Base-T Ethernet controller—Provides a 1 Gbps Ethernet link between the Routing Engines.
• Power circuits for the Routing Engine and the SCBE2-MX.
• LEDs—Provide status of the SCBE2-MX and the clocking interface.
• You can install up to three SCB-MXs in the MX960 chassis for a total of six switch fabrics and
six fabric planes. The SCB-MXs install vertically into the front of the MX960 chassis in the slots
labeled 0, 1, and 2/6.
NOTE: On the MX960, either a SCB-MX or a DPC can be plugged into slot 8. A third SCB-MX is
used only for switch fabric redundancy. Therefore, if an application does not require switch fabric
redundancy, a DPC can be used in slot 8.
• You can install one or two SCB-MXs in the MX240 and MX480 for a total of four switch fabrics
and eight fabric planes. The SCB-MX installs horizontally into the front of the chassis in the
slots labeled 0 and 1. If any slots are empty, you must install a blank panel.
Weight and Dimensions • Weight: 9.6 lb (4.4 kg) (with Routing Engine installed)
• Width: 17 in (43.2 cm)
• Depth: 22 in (55.9 cm)
• Height: 1.25 in (3.2 cm) height.
• Each fabric ASIC is configured in virtual plane mode, where two virtual planes exist on one
fabric ASIC. This means that the MX240 and MX480 require only a single SCB-MX to provide
line rate throughput, and an additional SCB-MX to provide 1 + 1 SCB redundancy.
• In redundant fabric mode, four virtual planes from the first SCB-MX will be in Active mode, and
four virtual planes from the second SCB-MX will be in Spare mode.
• In a non-redundant fabric mode, all eight virtual planes will be in Active mode to provide the
maximum fabric bandwidth.
160 W at 40° C
155 W at 25° C
SCB-MX LEDs
Three LEDs on the SCB indicate the status of the SCB. The LEDs, labeled FABRIC ACTIVE,
FABRIC ONLY, and OK/FAIL, are located directly on the SCB. Table 47 on page 114 describes
the functions of the SCB LEDs.
Table 48: SCB-MX Fabric Plane Scale and Redundancy Assuming Four PFEs per FPC
PFEs 12 24 48
SCBs 2 2 3
Switch Fabrics 4 4 6
Fabric Planes 8 8 6
Fabric Bandwidth Per Slot 160 Gbps 160 Gbps 120 Gbps
Preparation Overview
Table 49 on page 119 summarizes the physical specifications for the router chassis.
Standard chassis Standard chassis with 17.37 in. (44.11 cm) 23.0 in. (58.42 cm) 27.75 in. (70.49 cm)
dimensions midplane, two fan (excluding the (from front-mounting
trays, air filter, and mounting flanges or flange to chassis rear)
standard cable brackets)
manager: 150 lb Total depth (including
(68.04 kg) standard cable
manager)
Standard chassis with 27.75 in. (70.49 cm)
maximum
configuration: 350 lb
(158.76 kg)
Router with extended cable Chassis with 17.37 in. (44.11 cm) 23.0 in. (58.42 cm) 36.5 in. (92.7 cm) high
manager installed midplane, two fan (excluding the (from front-mounting
trays, air filter, and mounting flanges or flange to chassis rear)
extended cable brackets)
manager: 174 lb Total depth (including
(78.93 kg) extended cable
manager)
Chassis with extended approximately
cable manager and 29.00 in. (73.7 cm)
maximum
configuration: 374 lb
(169.64 kg)
Chassis with
components
removed: 174 lb
(78.93 kg)
Router with high-capacity Standard chassis with 17.37 in. (44.11 cm) Router with 27.75 in. (70.49 cm)
power supplies installed midplane, two fan (excluding the high-capacity power
trays, air filter, and mounting flanges or supplies installed.
standard cable brackets) Depth with
manager: 195 lb high-capacity AC
(88.45 kg) power supply is
30.65" (77.9 cm);
Standard chassis with depth with
maximum high-capacity DC
configuration: 395 lb power supply is
(179.17 kg) 32.85" (83.4 cm).
Craft interface 1.5 lb (0.68 kg) 17 in (43.2 cm) 8.5 in (21.6 cm) 6.25 in (15.9 cm)
DPC Maximum up to 14.5 lb 17 in (43.2 cm) 22 in (55.9 cm) 1.25 in (3.2 cm)
(6.6 kg)
FPC FPC2: 15 lb (6.8 kg) 17 in (43.2 cm) 22 in (55.9 cm) 2.5 in (6.4 cm)
PIC 2 lb (0.9 kg) 7.75 in (28.3 cm) 11.125 in (19.7 cm) 4.125 in (10.5 cm)
MPC weight (fixed 18.35 lb (8.3 kg) 17 in (43.2 cm) 22 in (55.9 cm) 1.25 in (3.2 cm)
configuration)
MPC (without MICs) 14 lb (6.4 kg) 17 in (43.2 cm) 22 in (55.9 cm) 1.25 in (3.2 cm)
MIC Maximum up to 1.2 lb 6.25 in (15.9 cm) 6.8 in (17.3 cm) 1.25 in (3.2 cm)
(0.54 kg)
AC power supply 5 lb (2.3 kg) each 14.5 in (36.8 cm) 4 in (10.2 cm) 1.75 in (4.4 cm)
High-capacity AC power 11.9 lb (5.4 kg) each 14.5 in (36.8 cm) 6.85 in (12.92 cm) 1.75 in (4.4 cm)
supply
DC power supply 3.8 lb (1.7 kg) 14.5 in (36.8 cm) 4 in (10.2 cm) 1.75 in (4.4 cm)
High-capacity DC power 15.8 lb (7.2 kg) 14.5 in (36.8 cm) 9.05 in (22.99 cm) 1.75 in (4.4 cm)
supply
Air filter 1 lb (0.5 kg) 16.7 in (42.4 cm) 19.7 in (50 cm) 0.43 in (1.1 cm)
SCB 9.6 lb (4.4 kg) (with 17 in (43.2 cm) 22 in (55.9 cm) 1.25 in (3.2 cm)
Routing Engine
installed)
SCBE 9.6 lb (4.4 kg) (with 17 in (43.2 cm) 22 in (55.9 cm) 1.25 in (3.2 cm)
Routing Engine
installed)
SCBE2 9.6 lb (4.4 kg) (with 17 in (43.2 cm) 22 in (55.9 cm) 1.25 in (3.2 cm)
Routing Engine
installed)
Routing Engine 2.4 lb (1.1 kg) 11 in (27.9 cm) 7.75 in (19.7 cm) 1.25 in (3.2 cm)
Routing Engine 2.4 lb (1.1 kg) 11 in (27.9 cm) 7.75 in (19.7 cm) 1.25 in (3.2 cm)
(RE-S-1800)
Routing Engine 2.69 lb (1.18 kg) 10.7 in (27.18 cm) 7.47 in (18.97 cm) 1.19 in (3.02 cm)
(RE-S-X6-64G)
Upper fan tray 13 lb (5.9 kg) 16.9 in (43 cm) 20.6 in (52.3 cm) 1.4 in (3.6 cm)
Lower fan tray 13 lb (5.9 kg) 16.9 in (43 cm) 20.6 in (52.3 cm) 1.4 in (3.6 cm)
High-capacity fan tray 13 lb (5.9 kg) 16.9 in (43 cm) 20.6 in (52.3 cm) 1.4 in (3.6 cm)
Standard cable manager 4.1 lb (1.9 kg 18.9 in (43 cm) 5.5 in (14 cm) 6.7 in (17 cm)
Extended cable manager 39 lb (2.3 kg) 24.5 in (62.2 cm) 30 in (78 cm) 24.25 in (61.6 cm)
Table 50 on page 122 specifies the environmental specifications required for normal router
operation. In addition, the site should be as dust-free as possible.
Description Value
NOTE: Install the router only in restricted areas, such as dedicated equipment
rooms and equipment closets, in accordance with Articles 110-16, 110-17, and
110-18 of the National Electrical Code, ANSI/NFPA 70.
Related • Tools and Parts Required to Maintain the MX960 Router on page 443
Documentation
• Definition of Safety Warning Levels
The checklist in Table 51 on page 122 summarizes the tasks you must perform when
preparing a site for router installation.
Select the type of rack or cabinet. “MX960 Cabinet Size and Clearance
Requirements” on page 128,
“MX960 Rack Requirements” on
page 123
Plan rack or cabinet location, including required “MX960 Cabinet Size and Clearance
space clearances. Requirements” on page 128,
“MX960 Rack Requirements” on
page 123,
“Clearance Requirements for Airflow
and Hardware Maintenance for the
MX960 Router” on page 126
If a rack is used, secure rack to floor and building “MX960 Rack Requirements” on
structure. page 123
Calculate the optical power budget and optical “Calculating Power Budget and
power margin. Power Margin for Fiber-Optic Cables”
on page 131
The router can be installed in many types of racks, including four-post (telco) racks and
open-frame racks. An example of an open-frame rack appears in Figure 38 on page 124.
The chassis is 17.37 in. (44.11 cm) wide. The router is designed for installation in a standard
19-in. rack, as defined in Cabinets, Racks, Panels, and Associated Equipment (document
number EIA-310-D) published by the Electronic Components Industry Association (ECIA)
(http://www.ecianow.org). The spacing of the holes between the left and right
front-mounting flanges and center-mounting brackets is 19 in. (48.3 cm) apart. However,
the inner edge of the rack rails must allow sufficient space for the width of the chassis.
With the use of adapters or approved wing devices to narrow the opening between the
rails, the router can fit into a 600-mm-wide rack, as defined in the four-part Equipment
The weight, height, and depth of the router depends on the type of cable manager
installed.
• The rack must have sufficient vertical usable space to accomodate the height of the
router: 27.75 in. (70.49 cm) high (approximately 16 U.),. You can stack three MX960
routers with the standard cable manager in a rack that has at least 48 U (89.3 in. or
2.24 m).
NOTE: A U is the standard rack unit defined in Cabinets, Racks, Panels, and
Associated Equipment (document number EIA-310-D) published by the
Electronic Components Industry Association (ECIA)
(http://www.ecianow.org).
• The location of the rack must provide sufficient space to accomodate the depth of the
router. The chassis is 23.0 in. (58.42 cm) deep, but The standard cable manager extends
the depth to 28.0 in. (71.1 cm).
• The rack must be strong enough to support the weight of the fully configured router,
up to 350 lb (158.76 kg). If you stack three fully configured routers, it must be capable
of supporting up to 1,050 lb (476.3 kg).
• The rack must have sufficient vertical usable space to accomodate the additional
height of the extended cable manager: 36.5 in. (92.7 cm) high (approximately 21 U).
You can stack two MX960 routers in a rack that has at least 48 U (89.3 in. or 2.24 m).
• The rack must be able to accomodate the additional depth of the extended cable
manager. The chassis with the extended cable manager installed is29.00 in. (73.7 cm)
deep.
• The rack must be strong enough to support up to 374 lb (169.64 kg). If you stack two
fully configured routers, it must be capable of supporting up to 748 lb (339.28 kg).
The router can be mounted in any rack that provides holes or hole patterns spaced at 1U
(1.75 in.) increments. The mounting brackets and front-mount flanges used to attach
the chassis to a rack are designed to fasten to holes spaced at those distances.
Related • Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for the MX960 Router
Documentation on page 126
Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for the MX960 Router
When planning the installation site, you need to allow sufficient clearance around the
rack (see Figure 40 on page 127):
• For the cooling system to function properly, the airflow around the chassis must be
unrestricted.
• For service personnel to remove and install hardware components, there must be
adequate space at the front and back of the router. At least 24 in. (61 cm) is required
both in front of and behind the router. NEBS GR-63 recommends that you allow at
least 30 in. (76.2 cm) behind the router.
Airflow must always be from front to back with respect to the rack. The device must
not interfere with the cooling of other systems in the rack. Fillers must be used as
appropriate in the rack to ensure there is no recirculation of heated exhaust air back
to the front of the rack. Care must also be taken around cables to ensure that no leakage
of air in situations where recirculation may result.
• Additional clearance is required to accommodate the height and depth of the chassis
with the extended cable manager:
Figure 39: Chassis Dimensions and Clearance Requirements for the MX960 Router with
the Normal-Capacity Power Supplies
Total depth with 29.0”
extended cable manager (73.7 cm)
19.2" 17.4"
(48.7 cm) (44.2 cm)
g006000
Standard cable manager
Extended cable manager
Front-mounting flange
Figure 40: Chassis Dimensions and Clearance Requirements for the MX960 Router with
the Standard Cable Manager and High-Capacity DC Power Supplies
34.8"
24" (61 cm) (88.4 cm)
clearance required
39.3" (100 cm)
24.5"
clearance recommended
(62.2 cm)
The minimum size cabinet that can accommodate the router is 600 mm wide and
800 mm deep. A cabinet larger than the minimum requirement provides better airflow
and reduces the chance of overheating. To accommodate a single router, the cabinet
must be at least 16 U high. If you provide adequate cooling air and airflow clearance in a
cabinet that has at least 48 U (89.3 in. or 224 mm) of usable vertical space, you can
stack three routers with the standard cable manger installed, or two routers with the
extended cable manager installed.
The minimum front and rear clearance requirements depend on the mounting
configuration you choose. The minimum total clearance inside the cabinet is 39.4 in or
1000 mm. between the inside of the front door and the inside of the rear door.
Related • Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for the MX960 Router
Documentation on page 126
Before you install the router in a cabinet, you must ensure that ventilation through the
cabinet is sufficient to prevent overheating. Consider the following requirements to when
planning for chassis cooling:
• Ensure that the cool air supply you provide through the cabinet can adequately dissipate
the thermal output of the router.
• Ensure that the cabinet allows the chassis hot exhaust air to exit from the cabinet
without recirculating into the router. An open cabinet (without a top or doors) that
employs hot air exhaust extraction from the top allows the best airflow through the
chassis. If the cabinet contains a top or doors, perforations in these elements assist
with removing the hot air exhaust. For an illustration of chassis airflow, see
Figure 41 on page 129.
• Install the router as close as possible to the front of the cabinet so that the cable
management brackets just clear the inside of the front door. This maximizes the
clearance in the rear of the cabinet for critical airflow.
• Route and dress all cables to minimize the blockage of airflow to and from the chassis.
Related • Clearance Requirements for Airflow and Hardware Maintenance for the MX960 Router
Documentation on page 126
• Calculating Power Budget and Power Margin for Fiber-Optic Cables on page 131
• Understanding Fiber-Optic Cable Signal Loss, Attenuation, and Dispersion on page 133
• Routing Engine Interface Cable and Wire Specifications for MX Series Routers on page 134
Use the information in this topic and the specifications for your optical interface to
calculate the power budget and power margin for fiber-optic cables.
TIP: You can use the Hardware Compatibility Tool to find information about
the pluggable transceivers supported on your Juniper Networks device.
To calculate the power budget and power margin, perform the following tasks:
P =P –P
B T R
The following hypothetical power budget equation uses values measured in decibels
(dB) and decibels referred to one milliwatt (dBm):
P =P –P
B T R
P = 13 dB
B
P = P – LL
M B
P greater than zero indicates that the power budget is sufficient to operate the receiver.
M
Factors that can cause link loss include higher-order mode losses, modal and chromatic
dispersion, connectors, splices, and fiber attenuation. Table 53 on page 132 lists an
estimated amount of loss for the factors used in the following sample calculations. For
information about the actual amount of signal loss caused by equipment and other
factors, refer to vendor documentation.
Multimode—0.5 dB
Connector 0.5 dB
Splice 0.5 dB
Multimode—1 dB/km
The following sample calculation for a 2-km-long multimode link with a power budget
(P ) of 13 dB uses the estimated values from Table 53 on page 132 to calculate link loss
B
(LL) as the sum of fiber attenuation (2 km @ 1 dB/km, or 2 dB) and loss for five connectors
(0.5 dB per connector, or 2.5 dB) and two splices (0.5 dB per splice, or 1 dB) as well as
higher-order mode losses (0.5 dB). The power margin (P ) is calculated as follows:
M
P = P – LL
M B
P = 13 dB – 2 dB – 2.5 dB – 1 dB – 0.5 dB
M
P = 7 dB
M
The following sample calculation for an 8-km-long single-mode link with a power budget
(P ) of 13 dB uses the estimated values from Table 53 on page 132 to calculate link loss
B
(LL) as the sum of fiber attenuation (8 km @ 0.5 dB/km, or 4 dB) and loss for seven
connectors (0.5 dB per connector, or 3.5 dB). The power margin (P ) is calculated as
M
follows:
P = P – LL
M B
P = 13 dB – 4 dB – 3.5 dB
M
P = 5.5 dB
M
In both examples, the calculated power margin is greater than zero, indicating that the
link has sufficient power for transmission and does not exceed the maximum receiver
input power.
This topic describes signal loss, attenuation, and dispersion in fiber-optic cable.
Single-mode fiber is so small in diameter that rays of light can reflect internally through
one layer only. Interfaces with single-mode optics use lasers as light sources. Lasers
generate a single wavelength of light, which travels in a straight line through the
single-mode fiber. Compared with multimode fiber, single-mode fiber has higher
bandwidth and can carry signals for longer distances.
Exceeding the maximum transmission distances can result in significant signal loss, which
causes unreliable transmission.
and single-mode transmission. An efficient optical data link must have enough light
available to overcome attenuation.
Dispersion is the spreading of the signal over time. The following two types of dispersion
can affect an optical data link:
• Chromatic dispersion—Spreading of the signal over time resulting from the different
speeds of light rays.
• Modal dispersion—Spreading of the signal over time resulting from the different
propagation modes in the fiber.
An efficient optical data link must have enough light to exceed the minimum power that
the receiver requires to operate within its specifications. In addition, the total dispersion
must be less than the limits specified for the type of link in Telcordia Technologies
document GR-253-CORE (Section 4.3) and International Telecommunications Union
(ITU) document G.957.
When chromatic dispersion is at the maximum allowed, its effect can be considered as
a power penalty in the power budget. The optical power budget must allow for the sum
of component attenuation, power penalties (including those from dispersion), and a
safety margin for unexpected losses.
Routing Engine Interface Cable and Wire Specifications for MX Series Routers
Table 54 on page 134 lists the specifications for the cables that connect to management
ports and the wires that connect to the alarm relay contacts.
NOTE: In routers where the Routing Engine (RE) and Control Board (CB) are
integrated into a single board, a CB-RE is known as Routing and Control Board
(RCB). The RCB is a single FRU that provides RE and CB functionality.
Table 54: Cable and Wire Specifications for Routing Engine and RCB Management and
Alarm Interfaces
Table 54: Cable and Wire Specifications for Routing Engine and RCB Management and
Alarm Interfaces (continued)
Pinout Specifications
2.25
End view
0.28
6 AWG conductor
0.55 diameter
each hole
Crimp area
g001188
0.08 0.25 0.625 0.37 All measurements in inches
Table 55: RJ-45 Connector Pinout for the Routing Engine ETHERNET Port
Pin Signal
1 TX+
2 TX–
3 RX+
Table 55: RJ-45 Connector Pinout for the Routing Engine ETHERNET Port (continued)
Pin Signal
4 Termination network
5 Termination network
6 RX–
7 Termination network
8 Termination network
RJ-45 Connector Pinouts for MX Series Routing Engine AUX and CONSOLE Ports
The ports on the Routing Engine labeled AUX and CONSOLE are asynchronous serial
interfaces that accept an RJ-45 connector. The ports connect the Routing Engine to an
auxiliary or console management device. Table 56 on page 141 describes the RJ-45
connector pinout.
Table 56: RJ-45 Connector Pinout for the AUX and CONSOLE Ports
Item Specification
Efficiency 88%
4100 W 1700 W
Item Specification
Maximum AC inrush current 76 A (38 A per feed at 264 VAC) 38 A per feed at 264 VAC
Efficiency ~88%
High-Capacity
Table 59 on page 145 lists the MX960 base system and cooling system power
requirements. Table 60 on page 145lists the FRU power requirements for Switch Control
Boards (SCB), Routing Engines, Modular Port Concentrators (MPC), Modular Interface
Cards (MIC), Dense Port Concentrators (DPC), and Flexible PIC Concentrators (FPC).
Typical power represents power under certain temperatures and normal operating
conditions.
Base system 50 W 50 W
Maximum Power
Component Part Number Requirement
“SCB-MX” on page 112 SCB-MX (applies to MX240, MX480, and MX960) 150 W
“SCBE-MX” on page 109 SCBE-MX (applies to MX240, MX480, and MX960) 160 W at 55° C
130 W at 40° C
120 W at 25° C
“SCBE2-MX” on page 104 SCBE2-MX (applies to MX240, MX480, and MX960) 185 W at 55° C
160 W at 40° C
155 W at 25° C
“SCBE3-MX” on page 98 SCBE3-MX (applies to MX240, MX480, and MX960) 275 W at 55°C
260 W at 40°C
245 W at 25C°
Routing Engines
RE-S-1800X2-8G
RE-S-1800X4-8G
RE-S-1800X2-16G
RE-S-1800X4-16G
RE-S-1800X4-32G
RE-S-2000-4096
RE-S-X6-64G
Maximum Power
Component Part Number Requirement
With optics:
607 W at 55° C, with SFPP ZR
optics
With optics:
607 W at 55° C, with SFPP ZR
and CFP LR4 optics
511 W at 25° C
511 W at 25° C
465 W at 40° C
440 W at 25° C
Maximum Power
Component Part Number Requirement
227 W at 40° C
219 W at 25° C
237 W at 40° C
228 W at 25° C
329 W at 40° C
315 W at 25° C
347 W at 40° C
333 W at 25° C
417 W at 40° C
400 W at 25° C
Maximum Power
Component Part Number Requirement
460 W at 40° C
438 W at 25° C
485 W at 40° C
461 W at 25° C
532 W at 40° C
503 W at 25° C
With optics:
607 W at 55° C, with SFPP ZR
and CFP LR4 optics
Maximum Power
Component Part Number Requirement
83 W at 25° C
83 W at 25° C
Maximum Power
Component Part Number Requirement
22.75 W at 40° C
21.5 W at 25° C
29 W at 55° C
27.75 W at 40° C
26.5 W at 25° C
36 W at 25° C
40 W at 40° C
39 W at 25° C
52 W at 55° C
50.5 W at 40° C
49 W at 25° C
MIC-3D-8CHDS3-E3-B 35 W at 40° C
34 W at 25° C
26.55 W at 25° C
Maximum Power
Component Part Number Requirement
33.96 W at 25° C
Maximum Power
Component Part Number Requirement
Related • Electrical Specifications for the MX960 DC Power Supply on page 159
Documentation
• Electrical Specifications for the MX960 AC Power Supply on page 143
The information in this topic helps you determine which power supplies are suitable for
various configurations, as well as which power supplies are not suitable because output
power is exceeded. You determine suitability by subtracting the total power draw from
the maximum output of the power supplies. Afterward, the required input current is
calculated. Finally, you calculate the thermal output. A sample configuration is provided
in Table 36 on page 89.
We recommend that you provision power according to the maximum input current listed
in the power supply electrical specifications (see “Electrical Specifications for the MX960
AC Power Supply” on page 143 and “Electrical Specifications for the MX960 DC Power
Supply” on page 159).
Both normal-capacity and high-capacity MX960 chassis with DC power supplies and
MX960 chassis with high-capacity AC power supplies are zoned. MX960 chassis with
normal-capacity AC power supplies have one overall zone. Zoning means that certain
components are powered by specific power supplies (see Table 36 on page 89 for
information on zoning). When calculating power requirements, be sure that there is
adequate power for each zone.
Three AC power supplies are mandatory for MX960 chassis with normal-capacity AC
power supplies.
Power Supply
Chassis Power Configuration Zone (PEM) Components Receiving Power
• Four high-capacity AC power supplies (using two feeds for each power supply); two
supplies are active, two are redundant
• Two SCBs with two (redundant) RE-1800x2 routing engines (SCB slot 0 and SCB slot
1)
• Five 16 port 10 GbE MPC with SFP+ interfaces (slots 7 through 11)
1. Calculate the power requirements (usage) using the values in “Power Requirements
for an MX960 Router” on page 144 as shown in Table 62 on page 154.
1
Base system MX960BASE-AC-HIGH 50 W —
High-capacity cooling system FFANTRAY-MX960-HC 320 W * 2 = 640 W Zone 0 (lower fan tray)
and Zone 1 (upper fan
tray)
RE-S-1800X2-8G 90 W
RE-S-1800X2-8G 90 W
1
Divided equally between zone 0 and zone 1.
2. Evaluate the power budget, including the budget for each zone if applicable. In this
step, we check the required power against the maximum output power of available
power supply options.
Table 63 on page 154 lists the power supplies, their maximum output power, and
unused power (or a power deficit).
Maximum Output
Power of Power Maximum Output Nonzoned Zone 0 Unused Zone 1 Unused
1 2
Power Supply Supply Power for System Unused Power Power Power
Maximum Output
Power of Power Maximum Output Nonzoned Zone 0 Unused Zone 1 Unused
1 2
Power Supply Supply Power for System Unused Power Power Power
MX960 AC 1700 W (one feed) 3400 W (one feed) – Power exceeded Power exceeded
high-capacity
4100 W (two feeds) 8200 W (two feeds) 1165 W 875 W
MX960 DC 1700 W (one feed) 3400 W (one feed) – Power exceeded Power exceeded
high-capacity
4100 W (two feeds) 8200 W (two feeds) 1165 W 875 W
1
For this configuration, output power is 2935 W.
2
For this configuration, output power is 3225 W.
3. Calculate input power. In this step, the input power requirements for the example
configuration are calculated. To do this, divide the total output requirement by the
efficiency of the power supply as shown in Table 64 on page 155.
3
MX960 AC high-capacity ~88 % 3335 W
3
MX960 DC high-capacity 86 % 3413 W
1
These values are at full load and nominal voltage.
2
For this configuration, total power for zone 0 is 2935 W. The calculation method for
zone 1 is the same as zone 0.
3
Zone 0 requirement.
4. Calculate thermal output (BTUs). To calculate this, multiply the input power
requirement (in watts) by 3.41 as shown in Table 65 on page 156.
1
MX960 AC high-capacity 3335 * 3.41 = 11,372 BTU/hr
1
MX960 DC high-capacity 3413 * 3.41 = 11,638 BTU/hr
1
Zone 0 output. The calculation method for zone 1 is the same as for zone 0.
Each AC power supply has a single AC appliance inlet located in the chassis directly
above the power supply that requires a dedicated AC power feed. We recommend that
you use a dedicated customer site circuit breaker rated for 15 A (250 VAC) minimum for
each AC power supply, or as required by local code.
Each normal capacity AC power supply has a single AC appliance inlet located in the
chassis directly above the power supply that requires a dedicated AC power feed and
each high-capacity AC PEM accepts two AC feeds in two unique AC receptacles. Most
sites distribute power through a main conduit that leads to frame-mounted power
distribution panels, one of which can be located at the top of the rack that houses the
router. An AC power cord connects each power supply to the power distribution panel.
You can order detachable AC power cords, each approximately 8 ft (2.5 m) long that
supply AC power to the router. The C19 appliance coupler at the female end of the cord
inserts into the AC appliance inlet coupler, type C20 (right angle) as described by
International Electrotechnical Commission (IEC) standard 60320. The plug at the male
end of the power cord fits into the power source receptacle that is standard for your
geographical location. If you want to use two AC feeds, two power cords are needed for
each HC AC power supply. For more information about AC power supplies, see “MX960
AC Power Supply Description” on page 86 .
Table 66 on page 157 provides specifications and Figure 45 on page 157 depicts the plug
on the AC power cord provided for each country or region.
Europe (except Denmark, Italy, Switzerland, 220 or 230 VAC, 50 Hz AC CEE 7/7
and United Kingdom)
WARNING: The AC power cord for the router is intended for use with the
router only and not for any other use.
WARNING:
Translation from Japanese: The attached power cable is only for this product.
Do not use the cable for another product.
CAUTION: Power cords and cables must not block access to device
components or drape where people could trip on them.
Item Specification
Efficiency 99%
Item Specification
4100 W 1700 W
Maximum input current 128 A for both feeds (66 A and 62 A per feed) 52 A
rating @ 40 VDC input
voltage
Maximum DC inrush current 140.5 A for both feeds (70 A and 70.5 A per feed 70 A
Efficiency 86%
Table 59 on page 145 lists the MX960 base system and cooling system power
requirements. Table 60 on page 145lists the FRU power requirements for Switch Control
Boards (SCB), Routing Engines, Modular Port Concentrators (MPC), Modular Interface
Cards (MIC), Dense Port Concentrators (DPC), and Flexible PIC Concentrators (FPC).
Typical power represents power under certain temperatures and normal operating
conditions.
Base system 50 W 50 W
Maximum Power
Component Part Number Requirement
“SCB-MX” on page 112 SCB-MX (applies to MX240, MX480, and MX960) 150 W
“SCBE-MX” on page 109 SCBE-MX (applies to MX240, MX480, and MX960) 160 W at 55° C
130 W at 40° C
120 W at 25° C
“SCBE2-MX” on page 104 SCBE2-MX (applies to MX240, MX480, and MX960) 185 W at 55° C
160 W at 40° C
155 W at 25° C
“SCBE3-MX” on page 98 SCBE3-MX (applies to MX240, MX480, and MX960) 275 W at 55°C
260 W at 40°C
245 W at 25C°
Routing Engines
Maximum Power
Component Part Number Requirement
RE-S-1800X2-8G
RE-S-1800X4-8G
RE-S-1800X2-16G
RE-S-1800X4-16G
RE-S-1800X4-32G
RE-S-2000-4096
RE-S-X6-64G
With optics:
607 W at 55° C, with SFPP ZR
optics
With optics:
607 W at 55° C, with SFPP ZR
and CFP LR4 optics
511 W at 25° C
Maximum Power
Component Part Number Requirement
511 W at 25° C
465 W at 40° C
440 W at 25° C
227 W at 40° C
219 W at 25° C
237 W at 40° C
228 W at 25° C
329 W at 40° C
315 W at 25° C
Maximum Power
Component Part Number Requirement
347 W at 40° C
333 W at 25° C
417 W at 40° C
400 W at 25° C
460 W at 40° C
438 W at 25° C
485 W at 40° C
461 W at 25° C
Maximum Power
Component Part Number Requirement
532 W at 40° C
503 W at 25° C
With optics:
607 W at 55° C, with SFPP ZR
and CFP LR4 optics
Maximum Power
Component Part Number Requirement
83 W at 25° C
83 W at 25° C
22.75 W at 40° C
21.5 W at 25° C
29 W at 55° C
27.75 W at 40° C
26.5 W at 25° C
36 W at 25° C
40 W at 40° C
39 W at 25° C
52 W at 55° C
50.5 W at 40° C
49 W at 25° C
Maximum Power
Component Part Number Requirement
MIC-3D-8CHDS3-E3-B 35 W at 40° C
34 W at 25° C
26.55 W at 25° C
33.96 W at 25° C
Maximum Power
Component Part Number Requirement
Related • Electrical Specifications for the MX960 DC Power Supply on page 159
Documentation
• Electrical Specifications for the MX960 AC Power Supply on page 143
The information in this topic helps you determine which power supplies are suitable for
various configurations, as well as which power supplies are not suitable because output
power is exceeded. You determine suitability by subtracting the total power draw from
the maximum output of the power supplies. Afterward, the required input current is
calculated. Finally, you calculate the thermal output. A sample configuration is provided
in Table 36 on page 89.
We recommend that you provision power according to the maximum input current listed
in the power supply electrical specifications (see “Electrical Specifications for the MX960
AC Power Supply” on page 143 and “Electrical Specifications for the MX960 DC Power
Supply” on page 159).
Both normal-capacity and high-capacity MX960 chassis with DC power supplies and
MX960 chassis with high-capacity AC power supplies are zoned. MX960 chassis with
normal-capacity AC power supplies have one overall zone. Zoning means that certain
components are powered by specific power supplies (see Table 36 on page 89 for
information on zoning). When calculating power requirements, be sure that there is
adequate power for each zone.
Three AC power supplies are mandatory for MX960 chassis with normal-capacity AC
power supplies.
Power Supply
Chassis Power Configuration Zone (PEM) Components Receiving Power
• Four high-capacity AC power supplies (using two feeds for each power supply); two
supplies are active, two are redundant
• Two SCBs with two (redundant) RE-1800x2 routing engines (SCB slot 0 and SCB slot
1)
• Five 16 port 10 GbE MPC with SFP+ interfaces (slots 7 through 11)
1. Calculate the power requirements (usage) using the values in “Power Requirements
for an MX960 Router” on page 144 as shown in Table 62 on page 154.
1
Base system MX960BASE-AC-HIGH 50 W —
High-capacity cooling system FFANTRAY-MX960-HC 320 W * 2 = 640 W Zone 0 (lower fan tray)
and Zone 1 (upper fan
tray)
RE-S-1800X2-8G 90 W
RE-S-1800X2-8G 90 W
1
Divided equally between zone 0 and zone 1.
2. Evaluate the power budget, including the budget for each zone if applicable. In this
step, we check the required power against the maximum output power of available
power supply options.
Table 63 on page 154 lists the power supplies, their maximum output power, and
unused power (or a power deficit).
Maximum Output
Power of Power Maximum Output Nonzoned Zone 0 Unused Zone 1 Unused
1 2
Power Supply Supply Power for System Unused Power Power Power
Maximum Output
Power of Power Maximum Output Nonzoned Zone 0 Unused Zone 1 Unused
1 2
Power Supply Supply Power for System Unused Power Power Power
MX960 AC 1700 W (one feed) 3400 W (one feed) – Power exceeded Power exceeded
high-capacity
4100 W (two feeds) 8200 W (two feeds) 1165 W 875 W
MX960 DC 1700 W (one feed) 3400 W (one feed) – Power exceeded Power exceeded
high-capacity
4100 W (two feeds) 8200 W (two feeds) 1165 W 875 W
1
For this configuration, output power is 2935 W.
2
For this configuration, output power is 3225 W.
3. Calculate input power. In this step, the input power requirements for the example
configuration are calculated. To do this, divide the total output requirement by the
efficiency of the power supply as shown in Table 64 on page 155.
3
MX960 AC high-capacity ~88 % 3335 W
3
MX960 DC high-capacity 86 % 3413 W
1
These values are at full load and nominal voltage.
2
For this configuration, total power for zone 0 is 2935 W. The calculation method for
zone 1 is the same as zone 0.
3
Zone 0 requirement.
4. Calculate thermal output (BTUs). To calculate this, multiply the input power
requirement (in watts) by 3.41 as shown in Table 65 on page 156.
1
MX960 AC high-capacity 3335 * 3.41 = 11,372 BTU/hr
1
MX960 DC high-capacity 3413 * 3.41 = 11,638 BTU/hr
1
Zone 0 output. The calculation method for zone 1 is the same as for zone 0.
If you plan to operate a maximally configured DC-powered router with normal capacity
power suplies, we recommend that you provision at least 116 A (58 A per feed) @ –48
VDC (nominal) for the system. Use a customer site circuit breaker rated according to
respective National Electrical Code and customer site internal standards to maintain
proper level of protection for the current specified above.
If you plan to operate a DC-powered router at less than the maximum configuration, we
recommend that you provision a circuit breaker according to respective National Electrical
Code and customer site internal standards to maintain proper level of protection for the
current specified above or each DC power supply rated for at least 125% of the continuous
current that the system draws at –48 VDC.
The DC power supplies in slots PEM0 and PEM1 must be powered by dedicated power
feeds derived from feed A, and the DC power supplies in slots PEM2 and PEM3 must be
powered by dedicated power feeds derived from feed B. This configuration provides the
commonly deployed A/B feed redundancy for the system.
CAUTION: You must ensure that power connections maintain the proper
polarity. The power source cables might be labeled (+) and (–) to indicate
their polarity. There is no standard color coding for DC power cables. The
color coding used by the external DC power source at your site determines
the color coding for the leads on the power cables that attach to the terminal
studs on each power supply.
CAUTION: Power cords and cables must not block access to device
components or drape where people could trip on them.
Related • General Electrical Safety Guidelines and Electrical Codes for Juniper Networks Devices
Documentation
• MX960 DC Power Supply on page 92
The accessory box shipped with the router includes the cable lugs that attach to the
terminal studs of each power supply (see Figure 47 on page 175).
2.25
End view
0.55 0.28
2 holes 4 AWG
conductor
Crimp area
g001544
0.08 0.25 0.63 0.37 All measurements in inches
Table 76 on page 175 summarizes the specifications for the power cables, which you must
supply.
2
Power Eight 4-AWG (13.3 mm ), minimum 60°C wire, or as required by the local
code
CAUTION: You must ensure that power connections maintain the proper
polarity. The power source cables might be labeled (+) and (–) to indicate
their polarity. There is no standard color coding for DC power cables. The
color coding used by the external DC power source at your site determines
the color coding for the leads on the power cables that attach to the terminal
studs on each power supply.
• Tools and Parts Required to Unpack the MX960 Router on page 179
• Unpacking the MX960 Router on page 179
• Verifying the MX960 Parts Received on page 181
To unpack the router and prepare for installation, you need the following tools:
• 1/2-in. or 13-mm open-end or socket wrench to remove bracket bolts from the shipping
pallet
The router is shipped in a wooden crate. A wooden pallet forms the base of the crate.
The router chassis is bolted to this pallet. Quick Start installation instructions and a
cardboard accessory box are also included in the shipping crate.
The shipping container measures 21 in. (53.3 cm) high, 23.5 in. (60.0 cm) wide, and
32.5 in. (82.5 cm) deep. The total weight of the container containing the router and
accessories can range from 93 lb (42.2 kg) to 169 lb (76.7 kg).
NOTE: The router is maximally protected inside the shipping crate. Do not
unpack it until you are ready to begin installation.
1. Move the shipping crate to a staging area as close to the installation site as possible,
where you have enough room to remove the components from the chassis. While the
chassis is bolted to the pallet, you can use a forklift or pallet jack to move it.
4. Remove the front door of the shipping crate cover and set it aside.
5. Slide the remainder of the shipping crate cover off the pallet.
7. Remove the accessory box and the Quick Start installation instructions.
9. Remove the vapor corrosion inhibitor (VCI) packs attached to the pallet, being careful
not to break the VCI packs open.
10. To remove the brackets holding the chassis on the pallet, use a 1/2-in. socket wrench
and a number 2 Phillips screwdriver to remove the bolts and screws from the brackets.
11. Store the brackets and bolts inside the accessory box.
12. Save the shipping crate cover, pallet, and packing materials in case you need to move
or ship the router at a later time.
Related • Tools and Parts Required to Unpack the MX960 Router on page 179
Documentation
• Verifying the MX960 Parts Received on page 181
A packing list is included in each shipment. Check the parts in the shipment against the
items on the packing list. The packing list specifies the part numbers and descriptions of
each part in your order.
A fully configured router contains the router chassis with installed components, listed in
Table 77 on page 181, and an accessory box, which contains the parts listed in
Table 78 on page 182. The parts shipped with your router can vary depending on the
configuration you ordered.
Component Quantity
DPCs Up to 12
FPCs Up to 6
MPCs Up to 12
MICs Up to 24
PICs Up to 12
Routing Engines 1 or 2
SCBs Up to 3
Power supplies Up to 4
Fan trays 2
Air filter 1
Table 77: Parts List for a Fully Configured MX960 Router (continued)
Component Quantity
Blank panels for slots without components installed One blank panel for each slot not
occupied by a component
Part Quantity
Document sleeve 1
Related • Tools and Parts Required to Unpack the MX960 Router on page 179
Documentation
• Unpacking the MX960 Router on page 179
• Installing the MX960 Mounting Hardware for a Four-Post Rack or Cabinet on page 185
• Installing the MX960 Mounting Hardware for Front-Mounting in an Open-Frame
Rack on page 187
• Installing the MX960 Mounting Hardware for Center-Mounting in an Open-Frame
Rack on page 189
Before installing the router in a four-post rack or cabinet, install the large mounting shelf,
followed by the small mounting shelf. You must also remove the mounting brackets from
the chassis.
Table 79 on page 185 specifies the holes in which you insert cage nuts, if needed, and
screws to install the mounting hardware required in a four-post or cabinet rack (an X
indicates a mounting hole location). The hole distances are relative to one of the standard
U divisions on the rack. The bottom of all mounting shelves is at 0.04 in. (0.02 U) above
a U division.
Large Small
Hole Distance Above U Division Shelf Shelf
1. On the front rack rails, install cage nuts, if needed, in the holes specified in
Table 79 on page 185 for the large shelf and the spacer bars.
2. On the front of each front rack rail, partially insert a mounting screw into the hole
containing the lowest cage nut.
3. Install the large shelf on the front rack rails. Rest the bottom slot of each flange of
the large shelf on a mounting screw.
4. Partially insert a mounting screw into the top hole in each flange of the large shelf.
6. On the rear rack rails, install cage nuts, if needed, in the holes specified in
Table 79 on page 185 for the small shelf.
7. On the back of each rear rack rail, partially insert a mounting screw into the hole
containing the lowest cage nut.
8. Install the small shelf on the back rack rails. Rest the bottom slot of each flange of
the small shelf on a mounting screw. The small shelf installs on the back of the rear
rails, extending toward the center of the rack. The bottom of the small shelf should
align with the bottom of the large shelf.
9. Partially insert screws into the open holes in the flanges of the small shelf.
Figure 49: Installing the Mounting Hardware for a Four-Post Rack or Cabinet
After the mounting hardware is installed, proceed to “Installing the MX960 Router Using
a Mechanical Lift” on page 204.
Related • Installing the MX960 Mounting Hardware for Center-Mounting in an Open-Frame Rack
Documentation on page 189
Before front-mounting the router in an open-frame rack, install the large mounting shelf
on the rack, and remove the mounting brackets from the chassis. The small mounting
shelf is not needed.
Table 80 on page 188 specifies the holes in which you insert screws to install the mounting
hardware in an open-frame rack (an X indicates a mounting hole location). The hole
distances are relative to one of the standard U divisions on the rack. For reference, the
bottom of all mounting shelves is at 0.04 in. (0.02 U) above a U division.
1. On the rear of each rack rail, install cage nuts, if needed, in the holes specified in
Table 80 on page 188 for the large shelf.
2. Partially insert a mounting screw into the highest hole specified in Table 80 on page 188.
3. Hange the shelf over the mounting screws using the keyhole slots located near the
top of the large shelf flanges.
4. Partially insert screws into the open holes in the flanges of the large shelf.
Figure 50: Installing the Mounting Hardware for Front-Mounting in an Open-Frame Rack
Open-frame
rack
Large
mounting shelf
g003482
After the mounting hardware is installed, proceed to “Installing the MX960 Router Using
a Mechanical Lift” on page 204.
Related • Installing the MX960 Mounting Hardware for a Four-Post Rack or Cabinet on page 185
Documentation
• Installing the MX960 Mounting Hardware for Center-Mounting in an Open-Frame Rack
on page 189
Before center-mounting the router in an open-frame rack, you must install the large
mounting shelf on the rack. The small mounting shelf is not needed.
Table 81 on page 190 specifies the holes in which you insert screws to install the mounting
hardware in an open-frame rack (an X indicates a mounting hole location). The hole
distances are relative to one of the standard U divisions on the rack. For reference, the
bottom of all mounting shelves is at 0.04 in. (0.02 U) above a U division.
1. On the rear of each rack rail, partially insert a mounting screw into the highest hole
specified in Table 81 on page 190 for the large shelf.
2. Install the large shelf on the rack. Hang the shelf over the mounting screws using the
keyhole slots located near the top of the large shelf flanges.
3. Partially insert screws into the open holes in the flanges of the large shelf.
Figure 51: Installing the Mounting Hardware for Center-Mounting in an Open-Frame Rack
Open-frame
rack
Large
mounting shelf
g003482
After the mounting hardware is installed, proceed to “Installing the MX960 Router Using
a Mechanical Lift” on page 204.
Related • Installing the MX960 Mounting Hardware for a Four-Post Rack or Cabinet on page 185
Documentation
• Installing the MX960 Mounting Hardware for Front-Mounting in an Open-Frame Rack
on page 187
• Installing the MX960 Mounting Hardware for a Four-Post Rack or Cabinet on page 185
5. Lift the router on to the rack. Because of the weight of the router, we recommend that
you use a mechanical lift.
See “Installing the MX960 Router Using a Mechanical Lift” on page 204.
See “Connecting the MX960 Router to Management and Alarm Devices” on page 237.
Removing Components from the MX960 Router Chassis Before Installing It with a Lift
Before installing the router with a lift, you must first remove components from the chassis,
and reinstall the components the router is installed in the rack. With components removed,
the chassis weighs approximately 150 lb (68.04 kg).
1. Removing the Power Supplies Before Installing an MX960 Router with a Lift on page 195
2. Removing the Standard Cable Manager Before Installing an MX960 Router with a
Lift on page 196
3. Removing the Fan Trays Before Installing an MX960 Router with a Lift on page 197
4. Removing the SCBs Before Installing an MX960 Router with a Lift on page 199
5. Removing the DPCs Before Installing an MX960 Router with a Lift on page 200
6. Removing the FPCs Before Installing the MX960 Router with a Lift on page 202
Removing the Power Supplies Before Installing an MX960 Router with a Lift
Remove the leftmost power supply first and then work your way to the right. To remove
the AC or DC power supplies for each power supply (see Figure 52 on page 196):
1. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist, and connect
the strap to an approved site ESD grounding point. See the instructions for your site.
2. On an AC-powered router, move the AC input switch in the chassis above each power
supply to the off (O) position. On a DC-powered router, move the DC circuit breaker
on each power supply faceplate to the off (O) position.
We recommend this even though the power supplies are not connected to power
sources.
3. While grasping the handle on the power supply faceplate with one hand, use your
other hand to pull the spring-loaded locking pin in the release lever away from the
chassis and turn the release lever counterclockwise until it stops.
4. Let go of the locking pin in the release lever. Ensure that the pin is seated inside the
corresponding hole in the chassis.
WARNING: Do not touch the power connector on the top of the power
supply. It can contain dangerous voltages.
Figure 52: Removing a Power Supply Before Installing the MX960 Router
Removing the Standard Cable Manager Before Installing an MX960 Router with a Lift
To remove the standard cable manager (see Figure 53 on page 197):
1. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist, and connect
the strap to an approved site ESD grounding point. See the instructions for your site.
2. Using a 7/16-in. (11 mm) nut driver, unscrew the nuts on the corners of the standard
cable manager.
3. Grasp the bottom of the standard cable manager, and pull it straight out from the
studs on the front of the chassis.
Removing the Fan Trays Before Installing an MX960 Router with a Lift
To remove the upper or lower fan tray (see Figure 54 on page 198 and Figure 55 on page 199,
which illustrate the upper and lower fan trays):
1. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist, and connect
the strap to an approved site ESD grounding point. See the instructions for your site.
2. Loosen the captive screw on each side of the fan tray faceplate.
3. Grasp both sides of the fan tray, and pull it out approximately 1 to 3 inches.
4. Press on the two latches located on the inside of the fan tray to release the fan tray
from the chassis.
5. Place one hand under the fan tray to support it, and pull the fan tray completely out
of the chassis.
0
MASTER
1 YELL
OW ALAR
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE M RED ALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
g004042
0
MASTER
1 YELL
OW ALAR
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE M RED ALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
g004044
Removing the SCBs Before Installing an MX960 Router with a Lift
To remove the SCBs (see Figure 56 on page 200):
2. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist, and connect
the strap to an approved site ESD grounding point. See the instructions for your site.
4. Grasp the ejector handles, and slide the SCB about halfway out of the chassis.
5. Place one hand underneath the SCB to support it, and slide it completely out of the
chassis. Place it on the antistatic mat.
0
MASTER
1 YELL
OW ALAR
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE M RED ALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
g004048
1. Have ready an antistatic mat for the DPC. Also have ready rubber safety caps for each
DPC using an optical interface on the DPC that you are removing.
2. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist, and connect
the strap to an approved site ESD grounding point. See the instructions for your site.
3. Simultaneously turn both the ejector handles counterclockwise to unseat the DPC.
4. Grasp the handles, and slide the DPC straight out of the card cage halfway.
5. Place one hand around the front of the DPC and the other hand under it to support it.
Slide the DPC completely out of the chassis, and place it on the antistatic mat or in
the electrostatic bag.
When the DPC is out of the chassis, do not hold it by the ejector handles,
bus bars, or edge connectors. They cannot support its weight.
Do not stack DPC on top of one another after removal. Place each one
individually in an electrostatic bag or on its own antistatic mat on a flat,
stable surface.
0
MASTER
1 YELL
OW ALAR
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE M RED ALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
OK/FAIL 1 0
1 0
0/0 0/5 2/0 2/5
1 0 1 0 0
1
1/0 1/5
3/0 3/5
g004052
Removing the FPCs Before Installing the MX960 Router with a Lift
To remove an FPC (see Figure 58 on page 203):
1. Have ready an antistatic mat for the FPC. Also have ready rubber safety caps for each
PIC using an optical interface on the PIC that you are removing.
2. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist, and connect
the strap to an approved site ESD grounding point. See the instructions for your site.
3. Simultaneously turn both the ejector handles counterclockwise to unseat the FPC.
4. Grasp the handles, and slide the FPC straight out of the card cage halfway.
5. Place one hand around the front of the FPC and the other hand under it to support it.
Slide the FPC completely out of the chassis, and place it on the antistatic mat or in
the electrostatic bag.
When the FPC is out of the chassis, do not hold it by the ejector handles,
bus bars, or edge connectors. They cannot support its weight.
0
MASTER
1 YELL
OW ALAR
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE M RED ALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
OK/FAIL 1 0
1 0
0/0 0/5 2/0 2/5
1 0 1 0 0
1
1/0 1/5
3/0 3/5
g004052
• Tools Required to Install the MX960 Router with a Mechanical Lift on page 203
• Reinstalling Components in the MX960 Chassis After Installing It with a Lift on page 206
• Mechanical lift
• Removing Components from the MX960 Router Chassis Before Installing It with a Lift
on page 194
• Reinstalling Components in the MX960 Chassis After Installing It with a Lift on page 206
Because of the router's size and weight—up to 350 lb (158.8 kg) depending on the
configuration—you must use mechanical lift to install the router.
1. Ensure that the rack is in its permanent location and is secured to the building. Ensure
that the installation site allows adequate clearance for both airflow and maintenance.
2. Load the router onto the lift, making sure it rests securely on the lift platform.
3. Using the lift, position the router in front of the rack or cabinet, centering it in front of
the mounting shelf.
4. Lift the chassis approximately 0.75 in. above the surface of the mounting shelf and
position it as close as possible to the shelf.
5. Carefully slide the router onto the mounting shelf so that the bottom of the chassis
and the mounting shelf overlap by approximately two inches.
6. Slide the router onto the mounting shelves until the mounting brackets or
front-mounting flanges contact the rack rails. The shelves ensure that the holes in
the mounting brackets and the front-mounting flanges of the chassis align with the
holes in the rack rails.
8. To install the router in an open-frame rack, install a mounting screw into each of the
open mounting holes aligned with the rack, starting from the bottom.
9. Visually inspect the alignment of the router. To verify that the router is installed properly
in the rack, verify that all the mounting screws on one side of the rack are aligned with
the mounting screws on the opposite side and the router is level.
• Removing Components from the MX960 Router Chassis Before Installing It with a Lift
on page 194
• Reinstalling Components in the MX960 Chassis After Installing It with a Lift on page 206
After the router is installed in the rack, reinstall the removed components before booting
and configuring the router. You reinstall components first in the rear of the chassis, and
then in the front:
1. Reinstalling the Power Supplies After Installing the MX960 Router with a
Lift on page 206
2. Reinstalling the Fan Trays After Installing the MX960 Router with a Lift on page 207
3. Reinstalling the SCBs After Installing the MX960 Router with a Lift on page 209
4. Reinstalling the DPCs After Installing the MX960 Router with a Lift on page 210
5. Reinstalling the FPCs After Installing the MX960 Router with a Lift on page 212
6. Reinstalling the Standard Cable Manager After Installing an MX960 Router with a
Lift on page 213
Reinstalling the Power Supplies After Installing the MX960 Router with a Lift
Reinstall the rightmost power supply first and then work your way to the left. To reinstall
the AC or DC power supplies, follow this procedure for each power supply (see
Figure 60 on page 207, which shows the installation of the DC power supplies):
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. For an AC-powered router, move the AC input switch in the chassis above the power
supply slot to the off (O) position. For a DC-powered router, move the DC circuit
breaker on the power supply to the off (O) position.
We recommend this even though the power supplies are not connected to power
sources.
3. Ensure that the release lever below the empty power supply slot is locked in the
counterclockwise position (see Figure 60 on page 207).
If necessary, pull the spring-loaded locking pin in the release lever away from the
chassis and turn the release lever counterclockwise until it stops. Let go of the locking
pin in the release lever. Ensure that the pin is seated inside the corresponding hole in
the chassis.
4. Using both hands, slide the power supply straight into the chassis until the power
supply is fully seated in the chassis slot. The power supply faceplate should be flush
with any adjacent power supply faceplates.
The small tab on the metal housing that is controlled by the release lever must be
inside of the corresponding slot at the bottom of the power supply. This tab is used
to pull the power supply down in the chassis slot, prior to removing the power supply.
5. While firmly pushing the handle on the power supply faceplate with one hand, use
your other hand to pull the spring-loaded locking pin in the release lever away from
the chassis and turn the release lever clockwise until it stops.
6. Let go of the locking pin in the release lever. Ensure that the pin is seated inside the
corresponding hole in the chassis.
Reinstalling the Fan Trays After Installing the MX960 Router with a Lift
To reinstall the fan trays (see Figure 61 on page 208 and Figure 62 on page 209):
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Grasp the fan tray on each side, and insert it straight into the chassis. Note the correct
orientation by the "this side up" label on the top surface of the fan tray.
3. Tighten the captive screws on each side of the fan tray faceplate to secure it in the
chassis.
0
MASTER
1 YELL
OW ALAR
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE M RED ALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
g004043
0
MASTER
1 YELL
OW ALAR
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE M RED ALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
g004045
Reinstalling the SCBs After Installing the MX960 Router with a Lift
To reinstall an SCB (see Figure 63 on page 210):
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Carefully align the sides of the SCB with the guides inside the chassis.
3. Slide the SCB into the chassis until you feel resistance, carefully ensuring that it is
correctly aligned.
4. Grasp both ejector handles, and rotate them simultaneously clockwise until the SCB
is fully seated.
5. Place the ejector handles in their proper position, vertically and toward the center of
the board. To avoid blocking the visibility of the LEDs position the ejectors over the
PARK icon.
0
MASTER
1 YELLOW ALARM
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE RED ALARM
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
g004049
Reinstalling the DPCs After Installing the MX960 Router with a Lift
To reinstall a DPC (see Figure 64 on page 211):
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Take each DPC to be installed out of its electrostatic bag, and identify the slot on the
DPC where it will be connected.
3. Verify that each fiber-optic DPC has a rubber safety cap covering the transceiver. If it
does not, cover the transceiver with a safety cap.
4. Locate the slot in the DPC card cage in which you plan to install the DPC.
5. Ensure that the DPC is right-side up, with the text on the faceplate of the DPC facing
upward.
6. Lift the DPC into place, and carefully align first the bottom, then the top of the DPC
with the guides inside the card cage.
7. Slide the DPC all the way into the card cage until you feel resistance.
8. Grasp both ejector handles, and rotate them simultaneously clockwise until the DPC
is fully seated.
0
MASTER
1 YELL
OW ALAR
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE M RED ALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
OK/FAIL 1 0
1 0
0/0 0/5 2/0 2/5
1 0 1 0 0
1
1/0 1/5
3/0 3/5
g004053
Reinstalling the FPCs After Installing the MX960 Router with a Lift
To reinstall an FPC (see Figure 65 on page 213):
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Place the FPC on an antistatic mat, or remove it from its electrostatic bag.
3. Identify the two DPC slots on the router where the FPC will be installed.
4. Verify that each fiber-optic transceiver on the PIC is covered by a rubber safety cap.
If it does not, cover the transceiver with a safety cap.
6. Lift the FPC into place, and carefully align the sides of the FPC with the guides inside
the card cage.
7. Slide the FPC all the way into the card cage until you feel resistance.
8. Grasp both ejector handles, and rotate them clockwise simultaneously until the FPC
is fully seated.
0
MASTER
1 YELLOW
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE ALAR
M REDALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
g004404
Reinstalling the Standard Cable Manager After Installing an MX960 Router with a Lift
To reinstall the standard cable manager (see Figure 66 on page 214):
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Position the cable manager on the studs on the lower front of the chassis.
3. Insert the nuts on the corners in the cable manager onto the studs on the chassis.
4. Using a 7/16-in. (11 mm) nut driver, tighten the nuts securely.
• Removing Components from the MX960 Router Chassis Before Installing It with a Lift
on page 194
• Tools and Parts Required for MX960 Router Grounding and Power
Connections on page 215
• Grounding the MX960 Router on page 216
• Connecting Power to an AC-Powered MX960 Router with Normal-Capacity Power
Supplies on page 217
• Connecting Power to an AC-Powered MX960 Router with High-Capacity Power
Supplies on page 219
• Powering On an AC-Powered MX960 Router with Normal Capacity Power
Supplies on page 222
• Connecting Power to a DC-Powered MX960 Router with Normal-Capacity Power
Supplies on page 223
• Connecting Power to a DC-Powered MX960 Router with High-Capacity Power
Supplies on page 226
• Powering On a DC-Powered MX960 Router with Normal Capacity Power
Supplies on page 230
• Powering Off the MX960 Router on page 232
• Connecting an MX960 AC Power Supply Cord on page 233
• Connecting an MX960 DC Power Supply Cable on page 234
Tools and Parts Required for MX960 Router Grounding and Power Connections
To ground and provide power to the router, you need the following tools and parts:
• 7/16-in. (11 mm) hexagonal-head external drive socket wrench, or nut driver, with a
torque range between 23 lb-in. (2.6 Nm) and 25 lb-in. (2.8 Nm) tightening torque, for
tightening nuts to terminal studs on each power supply on a DC-powered router.
• Wire cutters
CAUTION: The maximum torque rating of the terminal studs on the DC power
supply is 58 lb-in. (6.5 Nm). The terminal studs may be damaged if excessive
torque is applied. Use only a torque-controlled driver or socket wrench to
tighten nuts on the DC power supply terminal studs. Use an
appropriately-sized driver or socket wrench. Ensure that the driver is
undamaged and properly calibrated and that you have been trained in its
use. You may wish to use a driver that is designed to prevent overtorque when
the preset torque level is achieved.
You ground the router by connecting a grounding cable to earth ground and then attaching
it to the chassis grounding points using two screws. You must provide the grounding
cables (the cable lugs are supplied with the router).
1. Verify that a licensed electrician has attached the cable lug provided with the router
to the grounding cable.
2. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist, and connect
the strap to an approved site ESD grounding point. See the instructions for your site.
3. Ensure that all grounding surfaces are clean and brought to a bright finish before
grounding connections are made.
5. Detach the ESD grounding strap from the site ESD grounding point.
6. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
7. Place the grounding cable lug over the grounding points on the rear of the chassis.
The left pair is sized for M6 screws, and the right pair is sized for UNC 1/4-20 screws.
8. Secure the grounding cable lug to the grounding points, first with the washers, then
with the screws.
9. Dress the grounding cable and verify that it does not touch or block access to router
components, and that it does not drape where people could trip on it.
CAUTION: Do not mix AC and DC power supply modules within the same
router. Damage to the router might occur.
The AC appliance inlets are located in the chassis directly above the power supplies.
To connect the AC power cords to the router (see Figure 67 on page 218):
1. Locate the power cords shipped with the router, which should have a plug appropriate
for your geographical location.
2. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
3. Move the AC input switch, which is to the right of the appliance inlet on the chassis,
to the off (O) position.
4. Connect the power cord into the appliance inlet located in the chassis directly above
the AC power supply.
5. Insert the power cord plug into an external AC power source receptacle.
6. Dress the power cord appropriately. Verify that the power cord does not block the air
exhaust and access to router components, or drape where people could trip on it.
NOTE: A minimum of two AC nominal 220 VAC 20 amp power cords are
required for this procedure.
To install an MX960 high-capacity AC power supply, use the following procedure (see
Figure 68 on page 219).
1. Verify that the power switch on the power supply is in the off (O) position.
2. Ensure that the release lever below the empty power supply slot is locked in the
counterclockwise position (see Figure 68 on page 219).
Air exhaust
Input mode
switch
AC Power
supplies
g017591
Power supply
ejectors
If necessary, pull the spring-loaded locking pin in the release lever away from the
chassis and turn the release lever counterclockwise until it stops. Let go of the locking
pin in the release lever. Ensure that the pin is seated inside the corresponding hole in
the chassis.
3. On the power supply, rotate the metal cover away from the input mode switch to
expose the switch.
4. Move the input mode switch to position 0 for one feed or position 1 for two feeds (see
Figure 69 on page 220).
1
0 1
0
g006057
CAUTION: Do not use a pencil, because fragments can break off and cause
damage to the power supply.
5. Using both hands, slide the power supply straight into the chassis until the power
supply is fully seated in the chassis slot. The power supply faceplate will protrude
beyond the chassis.
The small tab on the metal housing that is controlled by the release lever must be
inside of the corresponding slot at the bottom of the power supply (see
Figure 69 on page 220). This tab is used to pull the power supply down in the chassis
slot, prior to removing the power supply.
6. While firmly pushing the handle on the power supply faceplate with one hand, use
your other hand to pull the spring-loaded locking pin in the release lever away from
the chassis and turn the release lever clockwise until it stops.
7. Let go of the locking pin in the release lever. Ensure that the pin is seated inside the
corresponding hole in the chassis.
8. Locate a power cord with the type of plug appropriate for your geographical location
(see “AC Power Cord Specifications for the MX960 Router” on page 156).
9. Plug the power cord into the corresponding appliance inlet located in the chassis
directly above the power supply. This is the recommend receptacle when using the
power supply in one-feed mode. If using the power supply in two-feed mode, plug the
second power cord into the receptacle on the power supply.
NOTE: To use HC-PSs with full capacity you have to switch them to two
feed mode and use two power corders per HC-PS.
10. Dress the power cords appropriately. Verify that the power cord does not block the
air exhaust and access to router components, and that they do not drape where people
could trip on them.
11. Move the AC input switch above the power supply to the on (—) position. This is the
only switch you have to turn on if you are using the power supply in one feed mode. If
using the power supply in two-feed mode, move the power switch on the power supply
to the on position. Remember to turn on both switches when operating the power
supply in two-feed mode.
12. If the power supply is correctly installed and functioning normally, the AC1 OK, AC2 OK
(two-feed mode only) DC OK LEDs light steadily, and the PS FAIL LED is not lit. See
Table 82 on page 221.
LEDs
Connected DIP Switch
Inputs Position AC-1 OK AC-2 OK DC OK PS FAIL
LEDs
Connected DIP Switch
Inputs Position AC-1 OK AC-2 OK DC OK PS FAIL
Note: The corresponding appliance inlet located in the chassis directly above the power supply is the recommend receptacle when
using the power supply in one feed mode. If using the power supply in two-feed mode, plug the second power cord into the
receptacle on the power supply
Note: PDM in the above table stands for Power Distribution Module.
13. Repeat steps 1-12 for installing power supplies in slots 1, 2, and 3, where required.
1. Verify that the power supplies are fully inserted in the chassis.
2. Verify that each AC power cord is securely inserted into its appliance inlet.
3. Verify that an external management device is connected to one of the Routing Engine
ports (AUX, CONSOLE, or ETHERNET).
5. Switch on the dedicated customer site circuit breakers. Follow the ESD and safety
instructions for your site.
6. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
7. Switch the AC switch in the chassis above each power supply to the on (—) position.
8. Check that the AC power supply is correctly installed and functioning normally. Verify
that the AC OK and DC OK LEDs light steadily, and the PS FAIL LED is not lit.
If any of the status LEDs indicates that the power supply is not functioning normally,
repeat the installation and cabling procedures.
9. On the external management device connected to the Routing Engine, monitor the
startup process to verify that the system has booted properly.
NOTE: If the system is completely powered off when you power on the
power supply, the Routing Engine boots as the power supply completes
its startup sequence. Normally, the router boots from the Junos OS on the
CompactFlash card.
Related • Connecting Power to an AC-Powered MX960 Router with High-Capacity Power Supplies
Documentation on page 219
• Connecting the MX960 Router to Management and Alarm Devices on page 237
CAUTION: Do not mix AC and DC power supply modules within the same
router. Damage to the router might occur.
You connect DC power to the router by attaching power cables from the external DC
power sources to the terminal studs on the power supply faceplates. You must provide
the power cables (the cable lugs are supplied with the router).
1. Switch off the dedicated customer site circuit breakers. Ensure that the voltage across
the DC power source cable leads is 0 V and that there is no chance that the cable
leads might become active during installation.
2. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
3. Move the DC circuit breaker on the power supply faceplate to the off (O) position.
4. Remove the clear plastic cover protecting the terminal studs on the faceplate.
5. Verify that the DC power cables are correctly labeled before making connections to
the power supply. In a typical power distribution scheme where the return is connected
to chassis ground at the battery plant, you can use a multimeter to verify the resistance
of the –48V and RTN DC cables to chassis ground:
• The cable with very large resistance (indicating an open circuit) to chassis ground
is –48V.
• The cable with very low resistance (indicating a closed circuit) to chassis ground is
RTN.
CAUTION: You must ensure that power connections maintain the proper
polarity. The power source cables might be labeled (+) and (–) to indicate
their polarity. There is no standard color coding for DC power cables. The
color coding used by the external DC power source at your site determines
the color coding for the leads on the power cables that attach to the
terminal studs on each power supply.
6. Remove the nut and washer from each of the terminal studs. (Use a 7/16-in.
[11 mm] nut driver or socket wrench.)
7. Secure each power cable lug to the terminal studs, first with the split washer, then
with the nut (see Figure 70 on page 226). Apply between 23 lb-in. (2.6 Nm) and 25 lb-in.
(2.8 Nm) of torque to each nut. Do not overtighten the nut. (Use a 7/16-in. [11 mm]
torque-controlled driver or socket wrench.)
a. Secure each positive (+) DC source power cable lug to the RTN (return) terminal.
b. Secure each negative (–) DC source power cable lug to the –48V (input) terminal.
CAUTION: Ensure that each power cable lug seats flush against the surface
of the terminal block as you are tightening the nuts. Ensure that each nut
is properly threaded onto the terminal stud. The nut should be able to spin
freely with your fingers when it is first placed onto the terminal stud.
Applying installation torque to the nut when improperly threaded may
result in damage to the terminal stud.
NOTE: The DC power supplies in slots PEM0 and PEM1 must be powered
by dedicated power feeds derived from feed A, and the DC power supplies
in slots PEM2 and PEM3 must be powered by dedicated power feeds
derived from feed B. This configuration provides the commonly deployed
A/B feed redundancy for the system.
8. Loosen the captive screw on the cable restraint on the lower edge of the power supply
faceplate.
9. Route the positive and negative DC power cables through the left and right sides of
the cable restraint.
10. Tighten the cable restraint captive screw to hold the power cables in place.
11. Replace the clear plastic cover over the terminal studs on the faceplate.
12. Verify that the power cables are connected correctly, that they are not touching or
blocking access to router components, and that they do not drape where people could
trip on them.
Related • DC Power Cable Specifications for the MX960 Router on page 175
Documentation
• Preventing Electrostatic Discharge Damage to an MX960 Router
1. Verify that the power switch on the power supply is in the off (O) position.
2. On the power supply, rotate the metal cover away from the input mode switch to
expose the switch.
3. Move the input mode switch to position 0 for one feed or position 1 for two feeds (see
Figure 71 on page 227).
Air exhaust
Input mode
switch
DC Power
supplies
Power supply
g017593
ejectors
CAUTION: Do not use a pencil, because fragments can break off and cause
damage to the power supply.
4. Ensure that the voltage across the DC power source cable leads is 0 V and that there
is no chance that the cable leads might become active during installation.
5. Ensure that the release lever below the empty power supply slot is locked in the
counterclockwise position.
If necessary, pull the spring-loaded locking pin in the release lever away from the
chassis and turn the release lever counterclockwise until it stops. Let go of the locking
pin in the release lever. Ensure that the pin is seated inside the corresponding hole in
the chassis.
6. Using both hands, slide the power supply straight into the chassis until the power
supply is fully seated in the chassis slot.
The small tab on the metal housing that is controlled by the release lever must be
inside of the corresponding slot at the bottom of the power supply. This tab is used
to pull the power supply down in the chassis slot, prior to removing the power supply.
7. While firmly pushing the handle on the power supply faceplate with one hand, use
your other hand to pull the spring-loaded locking pin in the release lever away from
the chassis and turn the release lever clockwise until it stops.
8. Let go of the locking pin in the release lever. Ensure that the pin is seated inside the
corresponding hole in the chassis.
10. Remove the nut and washer from each of the terminal studs.
11. Secure each power cable lug to the terminal studs, first with the split washer, then
with the nut. Apply between 23 in-lb. (2.6 Nm) and 25 in-lb. (2.8 Nm) of torque to
each nut. Do not overtighten the nut. (Use a 7/16-in. [11-mm] torque-controlled driver
or socket wrench.)
a. On INPUT 0, attach the positive (+) DC source power cable lug to the RTN (return)
terminal as shown in Figure 71 on page 227. Repeat this step for INPUT 1 if using two
feeds.
b. On INPUT 0 attach the negative (–) DC source power cable lug to the –48V (input)
terminal. Repeat this step for INPUT 1 if using two feeds.
CAUTION: Ensure that each power cable lug seats flush against the surface
of the terminal block as you are tightening the nuts. Ensure that each nut
is properly threaded onto the terminal stud. The nut should be able to spin
freely with your fingers when it is first placed onto the terminal stud.
Applying installation torque to the nut when improperly threaded may
result in damage to the terminal stud.
NOTE: The DC power supplies in slots PEM0 and PEM1 must be powered
by dedicated power feeds derived from feed A, and the DC power supplies
in PEM2 and PEM3 must be powered by dedicated power feeds derived
from feed B. This configuration provides the commonly deployed A/B feed
redundancy for the system. For information about connecting to DC power
sources, see “Electrical Specifications for the MX960 DC Power Supply”
on page 159.
12. Verify that the power cabling is correct, that the cables are not touching, and that they
do not block access to router components or drape where people could trip on them.
13. Replace the clear plastic cover over the terminal studs on the faceplate.
15. Verify that the INPUT 0 OK or INPUT 1 OK LEDs on the power supply are lit green
steadily. If using two feeds, verify that both INPUT 0 OK and INPUT 1 OK LEDs on the
power supply are lit steadily. The INPUT OK will be lit amber if that input’s voltage is
in reverse polarity. Check the polarity of the power cables to fix the condition (see
Figure 72 on page 230 and Table 83 on page 229.
17. Verify that the DC OK LED is lit green steadily. See Table 83 on page 229 for information
on MX960 high-capacity DC LEDs.
DIP LEDs
Switch
Connected Inputs Position INP-0 OK INP-1 OK DC OK PS FAIL
18. Repeat steps 1-17 for installing power supplies in slots 1, 2, and 3, where required.
19. Install a blank panel over the power distribution modules, if available.
1. Verify that an external management device is connected to one of the Routing Engine
ports (AUX, CONSOLE, or ETHERNET).
3. Verify that the power supplies are fully inserted in the chassis.
4. Verify that the source power cables are connected to the appropriate terminal: the
positive (+) source cable to the return terminal (labeled RTN) and the negative (–)
source cable to the input terminal (labeled –48V).
5. Switch on the dedicated customer site circuit breakers to provide power to the DC
power cables. Follow your site’s procedures.
6. Check that the INPUT OK LED is lit steadily green to verify that power is present.
• Verify that the fuse is installed correctly, and turn on the breaker at the battery
distribution fuse board or fuse bay.
• Check the voltage with a meter at the terminals of the power supply for correct
voltage level and polarity.
8. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
9. On each of the DC power supplies, switch the DC circuit breaker to the center position
before moving it to the on (|) position.
NOTE: The circuit breaker may bounce back to the off (O) position if you
move the breaker too quickly.
11. Verify that the PWR OK LED is lit green steadily, indicating the power supply is correctly
installed and functioning normally.
If any of the status LEDs indicates that the power supply is not functioning normally,
repeat the installation and cabling procedures.
12. On the external management device connected to the Routing Engine, monitor the
startup process to verify that the system has booted properly.
NOTE: If the system is completely powered off when you power on the
power supply, the Routing Engine boots as the power supply completes
its startup sequence. Normally, the router boots from the Junos OS on the
CompactFlash card.
Related • Connecting Power to a DC-Powered MX960 Router with High-Capacity Power Supplies
Documentation on page 226
• Connecting the MX960 Router to Management and Alarm Devices on page 237
NOTE: After powering off a power supply, wait at least 60 seconds before
turning it back on.
1. On the external management device connected to the Routing Engine, issue the
request system halt both-routing-engines operational mode command. The command
shuts down the Routing Engines cleanly, so their state information is preserved. (If
the router contains only one Routing Engine, issue the request system halt command.)
2. Wait until a message appears on the console confirming that the operating system
has halted. For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
3. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
4. Move the AC input switch on the chassis above the AC power supply or the DC circuit
breaker on each DC power supply faceplate to the off (0) position.
1. Locate a replacement power cord with the type of plug appropriate for your
geographical location (see “AC Power Cord Specifications for the MX960 Router” on
page 156).
2. Plug the replacement power cord into the corresponding appliance inlet located in
the chassis directly above the power supply.
3. Insert the power cord plug into an external AC power source receptacle.
4. Dress the power cord appropriately. Verify that the power cord does not block the air
exhaust and access to router components, or drape where people could trip on it.
5. Move the AC input switch in the chassis above the power supply to the on (—)position
and observe the status LEDs on the power supply faceplate. If the power supply is
correctly installed and functioning normally, the AC OK and DC OK LEDs light steadily,
and the PS FAIL LED is not lit.
1. Locate a replacement power cable that meets the specifications defined in “Electrical
Specifications for the MX960 DC Power Supply” on page 159.
2. Verify that a licensed electrician has attached a cable lug to the replacement power
cable.
4. Secure the power cable lug to the terminal studs, first with the split washer, then with
the nut. Apply between 23 lb-in. (2.6 Nm) and 25 lb-in. (2.8 Nm) of torque to each
nut (see Figure 73 on page 235). Do not overtighten the nut. (Use a 7/16-in. (11 mm)
torque-controlled driver or socket wrench.)
CAUTION: Ensure that each power cable lug seats flush against the surface
of the terminal block as you are tightening the nuts. Ensure that each nut
is properly threaded onto the terminal stud. The nut should be able to spin
freely with your fingers when it is first placed onto the terminal stud.
Applying installation torque to the nut when improperly threaded may
result in damage to the terminal stud.
Terminal
studs
Cable
lug
Split
washer
Nut
g017594
5. Route the power cable through the cable restraint. Make sure that the cable does not
touch or obstruct any router components.
6. Tighten the cable restraint captive screw to hold the power cables in place.
7. Verify that the DC power cable is connected correctly, that it does not touch or block
access to router components, and that it does not drape where people could trip on
it.
8. Replace the clear plastic cover over the terminal studs on the faceplate.
10. Turn on the dedicated customer site circuit breaker to the power supply.
11. Verify that the INPUT OK LED on the power supply is lit steadily.
12. On each of the DC power supplies, switch the DC circuit breaker to the center position
before moving it to the on (|) position.
NOTE: The circuit breaker may bounce back to the off (O) position if you
move the breaker too quickly.
Observe the status LEDs on the power supply faceplate. If the power supply is correctly
installed and functioning normally, the PWR OK, BRKR ON, and INPUT OK LEDs light
green steadily.
Related • DC Power Cable Specifications for the MX960 Router on page 175
Documentation
• Disconnecting an MX960 DC Power Supply Cable on page 411
• Tools and Parts Required for MX960 Router Connections on page 237
• Connecting the MX960 Router to Management and Alarm Devices on page 237
• Connecting the MX960 Router to a Network for Out-of-Band Management on page 241
• Connecting the MX960 Router to a Management Console or Auxiliary Device on page 242
• Connecting an MX960 Router to an External Alarm-Reporting Device on page 243
• Connecting DPC, MPC, MIC, or PIC Cables to the MX960 Router on page 244
• Connecting the Alarm Relay Wires to the MX960 Craft Interface on page 245
To connect the router to management devices and line cards, you need the following
tools and parts:
• Wire cutters
Related • Connecting the MX960 Router to a Network for Out-of-Band Management on page 238
Documentation
• Connecting the MX960 Router to a Management Console or Auxiliary Device on page 238
• Connecting the MX960 Router to a Network for Out-of-Band Management on page 238
• Connecting the MX960 Router to a Management Console or Auxiliary Device on page 238
• Connecting an MX960 Router to an External Alarm-Reporting Device on page 240
2. Plug one end of the Ethernet cable (Figure 75 on page 238 shows the connector) into
the ETHERNET port on the Routing Engine. Figure 74 on page 238 shows the port.
3. Plug the other end of the cable into the network device.
See Also • Routing Engine Interface Cable and Wire Specifications for MX Series Routers on
page 134
• Tools and Parts Required for MX960 Router Connections on page 237
• Connecting DPC, MPC, MIC, or PIC Cables to the MX960 Router on page 244
• Connecting the MX960 Router to a Management Console or Auxiliary Device on page 238
2. Plug the RJ-45 end of the serial cable (Figure 77 on page 239 shows the connector)
into the AUX port or CONSOLE port on the Routing Engine. Figure 76 on page 239 shows
the ports.
3. Plug the female DB-9 end into the device's serial port.
NOTE:
For console devices, configure the serial port to the following values:
• Baud rate—9600
• Parity—N
• Data bits—8
• Stop bits—1
• Flow control—none
See Also • Routing Engine Interface Cable and Wire Specifications for MX Series Routers on
page 134
• Tools and Parts Required for MX960 Router Connections on page 237
• Connecting DPC, MPC, MIC, or PIC Cables to the MX960 Router on page 244
The terminal blocks that plug into the alarm relay contacts are supplied with the router.
2
They accept wire of any gauge between 28-AWG and 14-AWG (0.08 and 2.08 mm ),
which is not provided. Use the gauge of wire appropriate for the external device you are
connecting.
To connect an external device to an alarm relay contact (see Figure 78 on page 240):
1. Prepare the required length of wire with gauge between 28-AWG and 14-AWG (0.08
2
and 2.08 mm ).
2. While the terminal block is not plugged into the relay contact, use a 2.5-mm flat-blade
screwdriver to loosen the small screws on its side. With the small screws on its side
facing left, insert wires into the slots in the front of the block based on the wiring for
the external device. Tighten the screws to secure the wire.
3. Plug the terminal block into the relay contact, and use a 2.5-mm flat-blade screwdriver
to tighten the screws on the face of the block.
To attach a reporting device for the other kind of alarm, repeat the procedure.
See Also • Tools and Parts Required for MX960 Router Connections on page 237
• Connecting DPC, MPC, MIC, or PIC Cables to the MX960 Router on page 244
• Connecting the MX960 Router to a Management Console or Auxiliary Device on page 238
• Connecting the MX960 Router to a Network for Out-of-Band Management on page 238
Related • Tools and Parts Required for MX960 Router Connections on page 237
Documentation
• Replacing Connections to MX960 Routing Engine Interface Ports on page 340
• Connecting DPC, MPC, MIC, or PIC Cables to the MX960 Router on page 244
• Routing Engine Interface Cable and Wire Specifications for MX Series Routers on
page 134
2. Plug one end of the Ethernet cable (Figure 75 on page 238 shows the connector) into
the ETHERNET port on the Routing Engine. Figure 74 on page 238 shows the port.
3. Plug the other end of the cable into the network device.
Related • Routing Engine Interface Cable and Wire Specifications for MX Series Routers on
Documentation page 134
• Tools and Parts Required for MX960 Router Connections on page 237
• Connecting DPC, MPC, MIC, or PIC Cables to the MX960 Router on page 244
• Connecting the MX960 Router to a Management Console or Auxiliary Device on page 238
To use a system console to configure and manage the Routing Engine, connect it to the
appropriate CONSOLE port on the Routing Engine. To use a laptop, modem, or other
auxiliary device, connect it to the AUX port on the Routing Engine. Both ports accept a
cable with an RJ-45 connector. One serial cable with an RJ-45 connector and a DB-9
connector is provided with the router. To connect a device to the CONSOLE port and
another device to the AUX port, you must supply an additional cable.
2. Plug the RJ-45 end of the serial cable (Figure 77 on page 239 shows the connector)
into the AUX port or CONSOLE port on the Routing Engine. Figure 76 on page 239 shows
the ports.
3. Plug the female DB-9 end into the device's serial port.
NOTE:
For console devices, configure the serial port to the following values:
• Baud rate—9600
• Parity—N
• Data bits—8
• Stop bits—1
• Flow control—none
Related • Routing Engine Interface Cable and Wire Specifications for MX Series Routers on
Documentation page 134
• Tools and Parts Required for MX960 Router Connections on page 237
• Connecting DPC, MPC, MIC, or PIC Cables to the MX960 Router on page 244
To connect the router to external alarm-reporting devices, attach wires to the RED and
YELLOW relay contacts on the craft interface. (See Figure 78 on page 240.) A system
condition that triggers the red or yellow alarm LED on the craft interface also activates
the corresponding alarm relay contact.
The terminal blocks that plug into the alarm relay contacts are supplied with the router.
2
They accept wire of any gauge between 28-AWG and 14-AWG (0.08 and 2.08 mm ),
which is not provided. Use the gauge of wire appropriate for the external device you are
connecting.
To connect an external device to an alarm relay contact (see Figure 78 on page 240):
1. Prepare the required length of wire with gauge between 28-AWG and 14-AWG (0.08
2
and 2.08 mm ).
2. While the terminal block is not plugged into the relay contact, use a 2.5-mm flat-blade
screwdriver to loosen the small screws on its side. With the small screws on its side
facing left, insert wires into the slots in the front of the block based on the wiring for
the external device. Tighten the screws to secure the wire.
3. Plug the terminal block into the relay contact, and use a 2.5-mm flat-blade screwdriver
to tighten the screws on the face of the block.
To attach a reporting device for the other kind of alarm, repeat the procedure.
Related • Tools and Parts Required for MX960 Router Connections on page 237
Documentation
• Replacing Connections to MX960 Routing Engine Interface Ports on page 340
• Connecting DPC, MPC, MIC, or PIC Cables to the MX960 Router on page 244
• Connecting the MX960 Router to a Management Console or Auxiliary Device on page 238
• Connecting the MX960 Router to a Network for Out-of-Band Management on page 238
To connect the DPCs, MPCs, MICs, or PICs to the network (see Figure 84 on page 245 and
Figure 85 on page 245):
1. Have ready a length of the type of cable used by the component. For cable
specifications, see the MX Series Interface Module Reference.
2. Remove the rubber safety plug from the cable connector port.
3. Insert the cable connector into the cable connector port on the faceplate.
NOTE: The XFP cages and optics on the components are industry standard
parts that have limited tactile feedback for insertion of optics and fiber.
You need to insert the optics and fiber firmly until the latch is securely in
place.
4. Arrange the cable to prevent it from dislodging or developing stress points. Secure
the cable so that it is not supporting its own weight as it hangs to the floor. Place
excess cable out of the way in a neatly coiled loop.
CAUTION: Do not let fiber-optic cables hang free from the connector. Do
not allow the fastened loops of a cable to dangle, which stresses the cable
at the fastening point.
Fiber-optic cable
connector
g004928
Fiber-optic cable
Related • Connecting the MX960 Router to Management and Alarm Devices on page 237
Documentation
• Tools and Parts Required for MX960 Router Connections on page 237
To connect the alarm relay wires between a router and an alarm-reporting device (see
Figure 86 on page 246):
1. Prepare the required length of replacement wire with gauge between 28-AWG and
2
14-AWG (0.08 and 2.08 mm ).
2. Insert the replacement wires into the slots in the front of the block. Use a 2.5-mm
flat-blade screwdriver to tighten the screws and secure the wire.
3. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
4. Plug the terminal block into the relay contact, and use a 2.5-mm flat-blade screwdriver
to tighten the screws on the face of the block.
The MX240 router is shipped with Junos OS preinstalled and ready to be configured when
the MX240 router is powered on. There are three copies of the software: one on a
CompactFlash card in the Routing Engine, one on a rotating hard disk in the Routing
Engine, and one on a USB flash drive that can be inserted into the slot in the Routing
Engine faceplate.
When the router boots, it first attempts to start the image on the USB flash drive. If a
USB flash drive is not inserted into the Routing Engine or the attempt otherwise fails, the
router next tries the CompactFlash card (if installed), and finally the hard disk.
You configure the router by issuing Junos OS command-line interface (CLI) commands,
either on a console device attached to the CONSOLE port on the Routing Engine, or over
a telnet connection to a network connected to the ETHERNET port on the Routing Engine.
This procedure connects the router to the network but does not enable it to forward
traffic. For complete information about enabling the router to forward traffic, including
examples, see the Junos OS configuration guides.
root# cli
root@>
cli> configure
[edit]
root@#
5. Configure the name of the router. If the name includes spaces, enclose the name in
quotation marks (“ ”).
[edit]
root@# set system host-name host-name
[edit]
root@# set system login user user-name authentication plain-text-password
New password: password
Retype new password: password
[edit]
root@# set system login user user-name class super-user
[edit]
root@# set system domain-name domain-name
9. Configure the IP address and prefix length for the router’s Ethernet interface.
[edit]
root@# set interfaces fxp0 unit 0 family inet address address/prefix-length
10. Configure the IP address of a backup router, which is used only while the routing
protocol is not running.
[edit]
root@# set system backup-router address
[edit]
root@# set system name-server address
12. Set the root authentication password by entering either a clear-text password, an
encrypted password, or an SSH public key string (DSA or RSA).
[edit]
root@# set system root-authentication plain-text-password
New password: password
Retype new password: password
or
[edit]
root@# set system root-authentication encrypted-password encrypted-password
or
[edit]
root@# set system root-authentication ssh-dsa public-key
or
[edit]
root@# set system root-authentication ssh-rsa public-key
13. (Optional) Configure the static routes to remote subnets with access to the
management port. Access to the management port is limited to the local subnet. To
access the management port from a remote subnet, you need to add a static route
to that subnet within the routing table. For more information about static routes, see
the Junos OS Administration Library.
[edit]
root@# set routing-options static route remote-subnet next-hop destination-IP retain
no-readvertise
14. Configure the telnet service at the [edit system services] hierarchy level.
[edit]
root@# set system services telnet
[edit]
root@# show
system {
host-name host-name;
domain-name domain-name;
backup-router address;
root-authentication {
authentication-method (password | public-key);
}
name-server {
address;
}
}
interfaces {
fxp0 {
unit 0 {
family inet {
address address/prefix-length;
}
}
}
}
[edit]
root@# commit
[edit]
root@host# commit
18. When you have finished configuring the router, exit configuration mode.
[edit]
root@host# exit
root@host>
NOTE: To reinstall Junos OS, you boot the router from the removable media.
Do not insert the removable media during normal operations. The router does
not operate normally when it is booted from the removable media.
When the router boots from the storage media (removable media, CompactFlash card,
or hard disk) it expands its search in the /config directory of the routing platform for the
following files in the following order: juniper.conf (the main configuration file), rescue.conf
(the rescue configuration file), and juniper.conf.1 (the first rollback configuration file).
When the search finds the first configuration file that can be loaded properly, the file
loads and the search ends. If none of the file can be loaded properly, the routing platform
does not function properly. If the router boots from an alternate boot device, Junos OS
displays a message indication this when you log in to the router.
Related • Powering On an AC-Powered MX960 Router with Normal Capacity Power Supplies
Documentation on page 222
Field-replaceable units (FRUs) are router components that can be replaced at the
customer site. Replacing most FRUs requires minimal router downtime. The router uses
the following types of FRUs:
• Hot-pluggable FRUs—You can remove and replace these components without powering
off the router, but the routing functions of the system are interrupted when the
component is removed.
Table 84 on page 256 lists the FRUs for the MX960 router. Before you replace an SCB or
a Routing Engine, you must take the host subsystem offline.
To connect the router to management devices and line cards, you need the following
tools and parts:
• Wire cutters
Related • Connecting the MX960 Router to a Network for Out-of-Band Management on page 238
Documentation
• Connecting the MX960 Router to a Management Console or Auxiliary Device on page 238
Installing Components
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Grasp the craft interface with one hand, and hold the bottom edge of the craft interface
with the other hand to support its weight.
3. Orient the ribbon cable so that it plugs into the connector socket. The connector is
keyed and can be inserted only one way.
4. Align the bottom of the craft interface with the sheet metal above the card cage and
press it into place.
5. Tighten the screws on the left and right corners of the craft interface faceplate.
• Connecting the Alarm Relay Wires to the MX960 Craft Interface on page 245
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
4. Insert the air filter tray into the chassis by sliding it straight into the chassis until it
stops.
To install a fan tray (see Figure 89 on page 260 and Figure 90 on page 261):
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Grasp the fan tray on each side, and insert it straight into the chassis. Note the correct
orientation by the "this side up" label on the top surface of the fan tray.
3. Tighten the captive screws on each side of the fan tray faceplate to secure it in the
chassis.
0
MASTER
1 YELL
OW ALAR
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE M RED ALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
g004043
0
MASTER
1 YELL
OW ALAR
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE M RED ALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
g004045
Related • Preventing Electrostatic Discharge Damage to an MX960 Router
Documentation
• Removing an MX960 Fan Tray on page 324
1. Ensure that the ejector handles are not in the locked position. If necessary, flip the
ejector handles outward.
3. Carefully align the sides of the Routing Engine with the guides inside the opening on
the SCB.
4. Slide the Routing Engine into the SCB until you feel resistance, and then press the
Routing Engine's faceplate until it engages the connectors.
5. Press both of the ejector handles inward to seat the Routing Engine.
6. Tighten the captive screws on the top and bottom of the Routing Engine.
After the Routing Engine boots, verify that it is installed correctly by checking the FAIL,
RE0, and RE1 LEDs on the craft interface. If the router is operational and the Routing
Engine is functioning properly, the green ONLINE LED lights steadily. If the red FAIL LED
lights steadily instead, remove and install the Routing Engine again. If the red FAIL LED
still lights steadily, the Routing Engine is not functioning properly. Contact your customer
support representative.
To check the status of the Routing Engine, use the CLI command:
For more information about using the CLI, see the Junos OS documentation.
0
MASTER
1 YELL
OW ALAR
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE M RED ALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0
OK/FAIL 1 0 1
0
HDD
ONLIN E
MASTE R
OFFLIN E
ONLINE /
RESET
USB
AUX
CONSOL E
ETHERNE T
g004051
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Carefully align the sides of the Switch Control Board with the guides inside the chassis.
3. Slide the Switch Control Board into the chassis until you feel resistance, carefully
ensuring that it is correctly aligned.
4. Grasp both ejector handles, and rotate them simultaneously clockwise until the Switch
Control Board is fully seated.
5. Place the ejector handles in the proper position, horizontally and toward the center
of the board.
6. Check the LEDs on the Switch Control Board faceplate to verify that it is functioning
normally.
• The green OK/FAIL LED should light steadily a few minutes after the Switch Control
Board is installed.
• If the OK/FAIL LED is red, remove and install the Switch Control Board again. If the
OK/FAIL LED still lights steadily, the Switch Control Board is not functioning properly.
Contact your customer support representative.
7. Check the status of the Switch Control Board using the show chassis environment cb
command:
CB 0 status:
State Online Master
Temperature 25 degrees C / 77 degrees F
Power 1
1.2 V 1198 mV
1.5 V 1508 mV
1.8 V 1830 mV
2.5 V 5059 mV
3.3 V 6593 mV
5.0 V 5111 mV
12.0 V 12181 mV
1.25 V 1250 mV
3.3 V SM3 6587 mV
5 V RE 5078 mV
12 V RE 12026 mV
Power 2
11.3 V bias PEM 11253 mV
4.6 V bias MidPlane 4827 mV
11.3 V bias FPD 11408 mV
11.3 V bias POE 0 11446 mV
11.3 V bias POE 1 11408 mV
Bus Revision 6
FPGA Revision 0
CB 1 status:
A DPC weighs up to 14.5 lb (6.6 kg). Be prepared to accept its full weight.
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Place the DPC on an antistatic mat, or remove it from its electrostatic bag.
4. Verify that each fiber-optic transceiver is covered with a rubber safety cap. If it does
not, cover the transceiver with a safety cap.
6. Lift the DPC into place, and carefully align the sides of the DPC with the guides inside
the card cage.
7. Slide the DPC all the way into the card cage until you feel resistance.
8. Grasp both ejector handles, and rotate them clockwise simultaneously until the DPC
is fully seated.
9. Remove the rubber safety cap from each fiber-optic transceiver and cable.
10. Insert the cables into the cable connector ports on each DPC (see
Figure 94 on page 268).
11. Arrange the cable in the standard or extended cable manager to prevent it from
dislodging or developing stress points. Secure the cable so that it is not supporting its
own weight as it hangs to the floor. Place excess cable out of the way in a neatly coiled
loop. Placing fasteners on the loop helps to maintain its shape.
CAUTION: Do not let fiber-optic cables hang free from the connector. Do
not allow the fastened loops of a cable to dangle, which stresses the cable
at the fastening point.
12. Use one of the following methods to bring the DPC online:
• Press and hold the corresponding DPC online button on the craft interface until the
green OK LED next to the button lights steadily, in about 5 seconds.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
CAUTION: After the OK LED turns green, wait at least 30 seconds before
removing the DPC again, removing a DPC from a different slot, or inserting
a DPC in a different slot.
You can also verify that the DPC is functioning correctly by issuing the show chassis fpc
and show chassis fpc pic-status commands.
0
MASTER
1 YELL
OW ALAR
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE M RED ALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
OK/FAIL 1 0
1 0
0/0 0/5 2/0 2/5
1 0 1 0 0
1
1/0 1/5
3/0 3/5
g004053
An FPC takes up two DPC slots on the MX960 router. Up to six FPCs can be installed
vertically in the front of the router. The FPCs are hot-insertable and hot-removable. An
empty FPC3 weighs 14 lb (6.5 kg). A fully configured FPC can weigh up to 18 lb (8.2 kg).
Be prepared to accept its full weight.
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
3. Take each PIC to be installed in the replacement FPC out of its electrostatic bag, and
identify the slot on the FPC where it will be connected.
4. Verify that each fiber-optic PIC has a rubber safety cap covering the PIC transceiver.
If it does not, cover the transceiver with a safety cap.
6. Locate the two slots in the card cage in which you plan to install the FPC.
8. Lift the FPC into place, and carefully align the sides of the FPC with the guides inside
the card cage.
CAUTION: When the FPC is out of the chassis, do not hold it by the ejector
handles, bus bars, or edge connectors. They cannot support its weight.
9. Slide the FPC all the way into the card cage until you feel resistance.
10. Grasp both ejector handles, and rotate them clockwise simultaneously until the FPC
is fully seated.
11. If any of the PICs on the FPC connect to fiber-optic cable, remove the rubber safety
cap from each transceiver and cable.
12. Insert the appropriate cable into the cable connector ports on each PIC on the FPC.
13. Arrange the cable in the standard or extended cable manager to prevent it from
dislodging or developing stress points. Secure the cable so that it is not supporting its
own weight as it hangs to the floor. Place excess cable out of the way in a neatly coiled
loop. Placing fasteners on the loop helps to maintain its shape.
CAUTION: Do not let fiber-optic cables hang free from the connector. Do
not allow the fastened loops of a cable to dangle, which stresses the cable
at the fastening point.
14. Use one of the following methods to bring the FPC online:
• Press and hold the FPC online/offline button until the green OK LED next to the
button lights steadily, in about 5 seconds. The LEDs and online/offline button for
each FPC are located directly above it on the craft interface.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
CAUTION: After the OK LED lights steadily, wait at least 30 seconds before
removing the FPC again, removing an FPC from a different slot, or inserting
an FPC in a different slot.
You can also verify correct FPC and PIC functioning by issuing the show chassis fpc and
show chassis fpc pic-status commands described in “Maintaining MX960 FPCs” on page 453
and “Maintaining MX960 PICs” on page 464.
0
MASTER
1 YELLOW
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE ALAR
M REDALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
g004404
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. If you have used a dual-wide MIC and are now replacing it with two “single” MICs,
install the septum (see Figure 96 on page 272):
a. Place the MPC on a flat surface (if necessary, remove the MPC from the router as
described in “Removing an MX960 MPC” on page 374).
b. Position the septum in the center of the MPC so that it lines up with holes labeled
S on the top of the MPC.
c. Insert a screw into each of the two holes labeled S, and then tighten completely.
d. On the bottom of the MPC, insert a screw into each of the four holes labeled S, and
then tighten completely.
g005041
3. If the MIC uses fiber-optic cable, verify that a rubber safety cap is over each transceiver
on the faceplate. Install a cap if necessary.
4. On the MPC, pull the ejector lever that is adjacent to the MIC you are installing away
from the MPC faceplate.
5. Align the rear of the MIC with the guides located at the corners of the MIC slot.
6. Slide the MIC into the MPC until it is firmly seated in the MPC.
CAUTION: Slide the MIC straight into the slot to avoid damaging the
components on the MIC.
7. Verify that the ejector lever is engaged by pushing it towards the MPC faceplate.
8. If the MIC uses fiber-optic cable, remove the rubber safety cap from each transceiver
and the end of each cable.
9. Insert the appropriate cables into the cable connectors on the MIC.
10. Arrange each cable to prevent the cable from dislodging or developing stress points.
Secure the cable so that it is not supporting its own weight as it hangs to the floor.
Place excess cable out of the way in a neatly coiled loop.
CAUTION: Do not let fiber-optic cables hang free from the connector. Do
not allow the fastened loops of a cable to dangle, which stresses the cable
at the fastening point.
11. Use one of the following methods to bring the MIC online:
• Press its online/offline button. Use a narrow-ended tool that fits inside the opening
that leads to the button. Press the button until the MIC OK/FAIL LED lights green.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
The normal functioning status LED confirms that the MIC is online. You can also verify
correct MIC functioning by issuing the show chassis fpc pic-status command described
in “Maintaining MX960 MICs” on page 460.
g004924
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
a. Place the MPC on a flat surface (if necessary, remove the MPC from the router as
described in “Removing an MX960 MPC” on page 374).
g005040
MPC
3. If the MIC uses fiber-optic cable, verify that a rubber safety cap is over each transceiver
on the faceplate. Install a cap if necessary.
4. Pull the ejector lever above both MIC slots away from the router.
5. Align the rear of the MIC with the guides located at the corners of the MIC slot.
6. Slide the MIC into the MIC slot until it is firmly seated in the chassis.
CAUTION: Slide the MIC straight into the slot to avoid damaging the
components on the MIC.
7. Verify that the ejector levers are engaged by pushing them toward the router.
8. If the MIC uses fiber-optic cable, remove the rubber safety cap from each transceiver
and the end of each cable.
9. Insert the appropriate cables into the cable connectors on the MIC.
10. Arrange each cable to prevent the cable from dislodging or developing stress points.
Secure the cable so that it is not supporting its own weight as it hangs to the floor.
Place excess cable out of the way in a neatly coiled loop.
CAUTION: Do not let fiber-optic cables hang free from the connector. Do
not allow the fastened loops of a cable to dangle, which stresses the cable
at the fastening point.
11. Use one of the following methods to bring the MIC online:
• Press its online/offline button. Use a narrow-ended tool that fits inside the opening
that leads to the button. Press the button until the MIC OK/FAIL LED lights green.
The normal functioning status LED confirms that the MIC is online. You can also verify
correct MIC functioning by issuing the show chassis fpc pic-status command described
in “Maintaining MX960 MICs” on page 460.
0
MASTER
1 YELLOW ALARM
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE RED ALARM
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
Dual-wide MIC
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
g005052
An MPC installs vertically in the front of the router. The MPCs are hot-insertable and
hot-removable. A fully configured MPC can weigh up to 18.35 lb (8.3 kg). Be prepared to
accept its full weight.
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
3. Take each MIC to be installed in the replacement MPC out of its electrostatic bag,
and identify the slot on the MPC where it will be connected.
4. Verify that each fiber-optic MIC has a rubber safety cap covering the MIC transceiver.
If it does not, cover the transceiver with a safety cap.
6. Locate the slot in the card cage in which you plan to install the MPC.
8. Lift the MPC into place, and carefully align the sides of the MPC with the guides inside
the card cage.
CAUTION: When the MPC is out of the chassis, do not hold it by the ejector
handles, bus bars, or edge connectors. They cannot support its weight.
9. Slide the MPC all the way into the card cage until you feel resistance.
10. Grasp both ejector handles, and rotate them clockwise simultaneously until the MPC
is fully seated.
11. If any of the MICs on the MPC connect to fiber-optic cable, remove the rubber safety
cap from each transceiver and cable.
12. Insert the appropriate cable into the cable connector ports on each MIC on the MPC.
Secure the cables so that they are not supporting their own weight. Place excess cable
out of the way in a neatly coiled loop, using the cable management system. Placing
fasteners on a loop helps to maintain its shape.
CAUTION: Do not let fiber-optic cables hang free from the connector. Do
not allow the fastened loops of a cable to dangle, which stresses the cable
at the fastening point.
13. Use one of the following methods to bring the MPC online:
• Press and hold the corresponding MPC online button on the craft interface until the
green OK/FAIL LED next to the button lights steadily, in about 5 seconds.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
CAUTION: After the OK/FAIL LED lights steadily, wait at least 30 seconds
before removing the MPC again, removing an MPC from a different slot,
or inserting an MPC in a different slot.
You can also verify correct MPC and MIC functioning by issuing the show chassis fpc and
show chassis fpc pic-status commands described in “Maintaining MX960 MPCs” on
page 461 and “Maintaining MX960 MICs” on page 460.
0
MASTER
1 YELLOW ALARM
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE RED ALARM
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
g004911
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. If the PIC uses fiber-optic cable, verify that a rubber safety cap is over each transceiver
on the faceplate. Install a cap if necessary.
3. Align the notches in the connector at the rear of the PIC with the notches in the PIC
slot in the FPC and then slide the PIC in until it lodges firmly in the FPC.
CAUTION: Slide the PIC straight into the slot to avoid damaging the
components on the bottom of the PIC.
4. For an FPC3 PIC, turn the ejector handle at the top of the PIC faceplate clockwise,
then tighten the captive screw at the bottom of the faceplate to secure the PIC in the
FPC.
5. If the PIC uses fiber-optic cable, remove the rubber safety cap from each transceiver
and the end of each cable.
6. Insert the appropriate cables into the cable connectors on the PIC.
7. Arrange the cable in the standard or extended cable manager to prevent it from
dislodging or developing stress points. Secure the cable so that it is not supporting its
own weight as it hangs to the floor. Place excess cable out of the way in a neatly coiled
loop. Placing fasteners on the loop helps to maintain its shape.
CAUTION: Do not let fiber-optic cables hang free from the connector. Do
not allow the fastened loops of a cable to dangle, which stresses the cable
at the fastening point.
• Press the PIC offline/online button until the PIC LED lights green. For a PIC installed
in FPC3, use a narrow-ended tool that fits inside the opening that leads to the button.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
The normal functioning status LED confirms that the PIC is online. You can also verify
correct PIC functioning by issuing the show chassis fpc pic-status command described
in “Maintaining MX960 PICs” on page 464.
g004411
To install a cable:
1. Have ready a length of the type of cable used by the component. For cable
specifications, see the MX Series Interface Module Reference.
2. If the cable connector port is covered by a rubber safety cap, remove the cap.
3. Insert the cable connector into the cable connector port on the component faceplate.
4. Arrange the cable in the standard or extended cable manager to prevent it from
dislodging or developing stress points. Secure the cable so that it is not supporting its
own weight as it hangs to the floor. Place excess cable out of the way in a neatly coiled
loop. Placing fasteners on the loop helps to maintain its shape.
CAUTION: Do not let fiber-optic cables hang free from the connector. Do
not allow the fastened loops of a cable to dangle, which stresses the cable
at the fastening point.
5. Insert the other end of the cable into the destination port.
7. If the component is offline (its failure indicator LED is lit), use one of the following
methods to bring it online.
• Press and hold the corresponding online button on the craft interface until the
green OK LED next to the button lights steadily, in about 5 seconds.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
• Press the PIC offline/online button until the PIC LED lights green. For a PIC installed
in FPC3, use a narrow-ended tool that fits inside the opening that leads to the
button.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
• Press the MIC offline/online button until the MIC LED lights green.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
The normal functioning indicator LED confirms that the component is online. You can
also verify correct DPC or MPC functioning by issuing the show chassis fpc command
or the correct PIC or MIC functioning by issuing the show chassis fpc pic-status
command.
• Maintaining Cables That Connect to MX960 DPCs, MPCs, MICs, or PICs on page 465
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Move the AC input switch in the chassis above the empty power supply slot to the off
(O) position.
3. Ensure that the release lever below the empty power supply slot is locked in the
counterclockwise position (see Figure 102 on page 286).
If necessary, pull the spring-loaded locking pin in the release lever away from the
chassis and turn the release lever counterclockwise until it stops. Let go of the locking
pin in the release lever. Ensure that the pin is seated inside the corresponding hole in
the chassis.
4. Using both hands, slide the power supply straight into the chassis until the power
supply is fully seated in the chassis slot. The power supply faceplate should be flush
with any adjacent power supply faceplates.
The small tab on the metal housing that is controlled by the release lever must be
inside of the corresponding slot at the bottom of the power supply (see
Figure 102 on page 286). This tab is used to pull the power supply down in the chassis
slot, prior to removing the power supply.
5. While firmly pushing the handle on the power supply faceplate with one hand, use
your other hand to pull the spring-loaded locking pin in the release lever away from
the chassis and turn the release lever clockwise until it stops.
6. Let go of the locking pin in the release lever. Ensure that the pin is seated inside the
corresponding hole in the chassis.
7. Move the AC input switch in the chassis above the power supply to the on (—) position
and observe the status LEDs on the power supply faceplate. If the power supply is
correctly installed and functioning normally, the AC OK and DC OK LEDs light steadily,
and the PS FAIL LED is not lit.
1. Ensure that the voltage across the DC power source cable leads is 0 V and that there
is no chance that the cable leads might become active during installation.
2. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
3. Move the DC circuit breaker on the power supply faceplate to the off (O) position.
4. Ensure that the release lever below the empty power supply slot is locked in the
counterclockwise position (see Figure 103 on page 290).
If necessary, pull the spring-loaded locking pin in the release lever away from the
chassis and turn the release lever counterclockwise until it stops. Let go of the locking
pin in the release lever. Ensure that the pin is seated inside the corresponding hole in
the chassis.
5. Using both hands, slide the power supply straight into the chassis until the power
supply is fully seated in the chassis slot. The power supply faceplate should be flush
with any adjacent power supply faceplates.
The small tab on the metal housing that is controlled by the release lever must be
inside of the corresponding slot at the bottom of the power supply (see
Figure 103 on page 290). This tab is used to pull the power supply down in the chassis
slot, prior to removing the power supply.
6. While firmly pushing the handle on the power supply faceplate with one hand, use
your other hand to pull the spring-loaded locking pin in the release lever away from
the chassis and turn the release lever clockwise until it stops.
7. Let go of the locking pin in the release lever. Ensure that the pin is seated inside the
corresponding hole in the chassis.
8. Remove the clear plastic cover protecting the terminal studs on the faceplate.
9. Remove the nut and washer from each of the terminal studs.
10. Secure each power cable lug to the terminal studs, first with the split washer, then
with the nut. Apply between 23 lb-in. (2.6 Nm) and 25 lb-in. (2.8 Nm) of torque to
each nut (see Figure 104 on page 291). Do not overtighten the nut. (Use a
7/16-in. (11 mm) torque-controlled driver or socket wrench.)
a. Attach the positive (+) DC source power cable lug to the RTN (return) terminal.
b. Attach the negative (–) DC source power cable lug to the –48V (input) terminal.
CAUTION: Ensure that each power cable lug seats flush against the surface
of the terminal block as you are tightening the nuts. Ensure that each nut
is properly threaded onto the terminal stud. The nut should be able to spin
freely with your fingers when it is first placed onto the terminal stud.
Applying installation torque to the nut when improperly threaded may
result in damage to the terminal stud.
CAUTION: You must ensure that power connections maintain the proper
polarity. The power source cables might be labeled (+) and (–) to indicate
their polarity. There is no standard color coding for DC power cables. The
color coding used by the external DC power source at your site determines
the color coding for the leads on the power cables that attach to the
terminal studs on each power supply.
NOTE: The DC power supplies in slots PEM0 and PEM1 must be powered
by dedicated power feeds derived from feed A, and the DC power supplies
in PEM2 and PEM3 must be powered by dedicated power feeds derived
from feed B. This configuration provides the commonly deployed A/B feed
redundancy for the system. For information about connecting to DC power
sources, see “Electrical Specifications for the MX960 DC Power Supply”
on page 159.
11. Loosen the captive screw on the cable restraint on the lower edge of the power supply
faceplate.
12. Route the positive and negative DC power cables through the left and right sides of
the cable restraint.
13. Tighten the cable restraint captive screw to hold the power cables in place.
14. Replace the clear plastic cover over the terminal studs on the faceplate.
15. Verify that the power cabling is correct, that the cables are not touching, and that they
do not block access to router components or drape where people could trip on them.
17. Verify that the INPUT OK LED on the power supply is lit steadily.
18. On each of the DC power supplies, switch the DC circuit breaker to the center position
before moving it to the on (|) position.
NOTE: The circuit breaker may bounce back to the off (O) position if you
move the breaker too quickly.
You can install up to eight Application Services Modular Line Cards (AS MLCs) vertically
in the front of the MX960 router. The AS MLCs are hot-insertable and hot-removable.
An empty AS MLC weighs 10.5 lb (4.76 kg). A fully configured AS MLC can weigh up to
15.27 lb (6.93 kg). Be prepared to accept its full weight.
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
3. Take the AS MSC and AS MXC (the modular cards) to be installed in the AS MLC out
of its electrostatic bag. The AS MSC must be inserted in the top slot and the AS MXC
in the bottom slot.
4. Install the AS MSC and AS MXC into the appropriate slot on the AS MLC.
5. Locate the slots in the card cage in which you plan to install the AS MLC.
7. Lift the AS MLC into place, and carefully align the sides of the AS MLC with the guides
inside the card cage.
CAUTION: When the AS MLC is out of the chassis, do not hold it by the
ejector handles, bus bars, or edge connectors. They cannot support its
weight.
8. Slide the AS MLC all the way into the card cage until you feel resistance.
9. Grasp both ejector handles, and rotate them clockwise simultaneously until the AS
MLC is fully seated.
10. Use one of the following methods to bring the AS MLC online:
• Press and hold the AS MLC online/offline button until the green OK LED next to the
button lights steadily, in about 5 seconds. The LEDs and online/offline button for
each AS MLC are located directly above it on the craft interface.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
CAUTION: After the OK LED lights steadily, wait at least 30 seconds before
removing the AS MLC again, removing an AS MLC from a different slot, or
inserting an AS MLC in a different slot.
You can also verify correct AS MLC and AS MSC or AS MXC functioning by issuing the
show chassis fpc and show chassis fpc pic-status.
0
MASTER
1 YELLOWALARM
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE REDALARM
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0
g006678
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Align the notches in the connector at the rear of the AS MSC with the notches in the
AS MSC slot (slot 0—the top slot in the AS MLC ), and then slide the AS MSC in until
it lodges firmly in the AS MLC.
CAUTION: Slide the AS MSC straight into the slot to avoid damaging the
components on the bottom of the AS MSC.
• Press the AS MSC offline/online button until the LED light turns green.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
The normal functioning status LED confirms that the AS MSC is online. You can also
verify correct AS MSC functioning by issuing the show chassis fpc pic-status command..
g006674
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Align the notches in the connector at the rear of the AS MXC with the notches in the
AS MXC slot (slot 1—the bottom slot in the AS MLC), and then slide the AS MXC in
until it lodges firmly in the AS MLC.
CAUTION: Slide the AS MXC straight into the slot to avoid damaging the
components on the bottom of the AS MXC.
• Press the AS MXC offline/online button until the LED light turns green.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
The normal functioning status LED confirms that the AS MXC is online. You can also
verify correct AS MXC functioning by issuing the show chassis fpc pic-status command.
g006676
Installing an SFP or XFP Transceiver into an MX960 DPC, MPC, MIC, or PIC
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Take each transceiver to be installed out of its electrostatic bag, and identify the slot
on the component where it will be installed.
3. Verify that each transceiver is covered by a rubber safety cap. If it is not, cover the
transceiver with a safety cap.
4. Carefully align the transceiver with the slots in the component. The connectors should
face the component.
5. Slide the transceiver until the connector is seated in the component slot. If you are
unable to fully insert the transceiver, make sure the connector is facing the right way.
7. Remove the rubber safety cap from the transceiver and the end of the cable. Insert
the cable into the transceiver.
8. Verify that the status LEDs on the component faceplate indicate that the SFP or XFP
is functioning correctly. For more information about the component LEDs, see the MX
Series Interface Module Reference.
1. Place an electrostatic bag or antistatic mat on a flat, stable surface to receive the
CFP transceiver. Have ready a rubber safety cap for the CFP2 transceiver and the
cable.
2. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist, and connect
the strap to one of the ESD points on the chassis.
3. Label the cable connected to the CFP2 transceiver so that you can later reconnect it
to the correct CFP2 transceiver.
4. Disconnect the cable from the CFP2 transceiver. Immediately cover the transceiver
and the end of the cable with a rubber safety cap.
5. Arrange the cable in the cable management system to prevent it from dislodging or
developing stress points. Secure the cable so that it is not supporting its own weight
as it hangs to the floor. Place excess cable out of the way in a neatly coiled loop in
the cable management system. Placing fasteners on the loop helps to maintain its
shape.
6. Pull the ejector latch to the extreme end away from the CFP2 transceiver faceplate
to unseat the CFP2 transceiver from the PIC. Pull the CFP2 transceiver out of the PIC
and place it on the antistatic mat or in the electrostatic bag.
NOTE: You cannot remove the transceiver until you move the ejector latch
to the extreme end.
1. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist, and connect
the strap to one of the ESD points on the chassis.
2. Verify that a rubber safety cap covers the CFP transceiver, installing one if necessary.
3. Orient the CFP2 over the port in the PIC so that the connector end will enter the slot
first and the CFP2 connector faces the appropriate direction.
4. Slide the CFP2 into the slot. If there is resistance, remove the CFP2 and flip it so that
the connector faces the other direction.
5. Remove the rubber safety cap from the transceiver and the end of the cable, and
insert the cable into the transceiver.
6. Arrange the cable in the cable management system to prevent the cable from
dislodging or developing stress points. Secure the cable so that it is not supporting its
own weight as it hangs to the floor. Place excess cable out of the way in a neatly coiled
loop in the cable management system. Placing fasteners on the loop helps to maintain
its shape.
CAUTION: Do not let fiber-optic cable hang free from the connector. Do
not allow fastened loops of cable to dangle, which stresses the cable at
the fastening point.
7. Verify that the status LEDs on the PIC faceplate indicate that the CFP2 is functioning
correctly. You can also verify PIC functioning by issuing the show chassis fpc pic-status
command.
You can use the Hardware Compatibility Tool to find information about the pluggable
transceivers supported on your Juniper Networks device.
1. Place an electrostatic bag or antistatic mat on a flat, stable surface to receive the
CFP transceiver. Have ready a rubber safety cap for the CFP transceiver and the cable.
2. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist, and connect
the strap to the ESD point on the chassis.
3. Label the cable connected to the CFP transceiver so that you can later reconnect it
to the correct CFP transceiver.
4. Disconnect the cable from the CFP transceiver. Immediately cover the transceiver
and the end of the cable with a rubber safety cap.
5. Arrange the cable in the cable management system to prevent it from dislodging or
developing stress points. Secure the cable so that it is not supporting its own weight
as it hangs to the floor.
6. Unscrew the screws from the CFP transceiver faceplate to unseat the CFP transceiver
from the line card. Pull the CFP transceiver out of the line card and place it on the
antistatic mat or in the electrostatic bag.
1. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist, and connect
the strap to the ESD point on the chassis.
2. Verify that a rubber safety cap covers the CFP transceiver, installing one if necessary.
3. Orient the CFP over the port in the line card so that the connector end will enter the
slot first and the CFP connector faces the appropriate direction.
4. Slide the CFP into the slot. If there is resistance, remove the CFP and flip it so that the
connector faces the other direction.
5. Remove the rubber safety cap from the transceiver and the end of the cable, and
insert the cable into the transceiver.
6. Arrange the cable in the cable management system to prevent the cable from
dislodging or developing stress points. Secure the cable so that it is not supporting its
own weight as it hangs to the floor.
CAUTION: Do not let fiber-optic cable hang free from the connector. Do
not allow fastened loops of cable to dangle, which stresses the cable at
the fastening point.
7. Verify that any status LEDs on the line card faceplate indicate that the CFP is
functioning correctly. For more information about the line card LEDs, see the MX Series
5G Universal Routing Platform Interface Module Reference. You can also verify line card
functioning by issuing the show chassis fpc pic-status command.
1. Disconnecting the Alarm Relay Wires from the MX960 Craft Interface on page 303
2. Removing the MX960 Craft Interface on page 304
4. Connecting the Alarm Relay Wires to the MX960 Craft Interface on page 306
Disconnecting the Alarm Relay Wires from the MX960 Craft Interface
To disconnect the alarm relay wires from the router and an alarm-reporting device (see
Figure 109 on page 304):
2. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
3. Using a 2.5-mm flat-blade screwdriver, loosen the small screws on the face of the
terminal block and remove the block from the relay contact.
4. Using the 2.5-mm flat-blade screwdriver, loosen the small screws on the side of the
terminal block. Remove existing wires from the slots in the front of the block.
• Connecting the Alarm Relay Wires to the MX960 Craft Interface on page 245
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
3. Loosen the captive screws at the left and right corners of the craft interface faceplate.
4. Grasp the craft interface faceplate and carefully tilt it toward you until it is horizontal.
5. Disconnect the ribbon cable from the back of the faceplate by gently pressing on both
sides of the latch with your thumb and forefinger. Remove the craft interface from
the chassis.
• Disconnecting the Alarm Relay Wires from the MX960 Craft Interface on page 303
• Connecting the Alarm Relay Wires to the MX960 Craft Interface on page 245
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Grasp the craft interface with one hand, and hold the bottom edge of the craft interface
with the other hand to support its weight.
3. Orient the ribbon cable so that it plugs into the connector socket. The connector is
keyed and can be inserted only one way.
4. Align the bottom of the craft interface with the sheet metal above the card cage and
press it into place.
5. Tighten the screws on the left and right corners of the craft interface faceplate.
• Disconnecting the Alarm Relay Wires from the MX960 Craft Interface on page 303
• Connecting the Alarm Relay Wires to the MX960 Craft Interface on page 245
1. Prepare the required length of replacement wire with gauge between 28-AWG and
2
14-AWG (0.08 and 2.08 mm ).
2. Insert the replacement wires into the slots in the front of the block. Use a 2.5-mm
flat-blade screwdriver to tighten the screws and secure the wire.
3. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
4. Plug the terminal block into the relay contact, and use a 2.5-mm flat-blade screwdriver
to tighten the screws on the face of the block.
• Disconnecting the Alarm Relay Wires from the MX960 Craft Interface on page 303
To remove the standard cable manager (see Figure 113 on page 307):
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Using a 7/16-in. (11 mm) nut driver, unscrew the nuts on the corners of the standard
cable manager.
3. Grasp the bottom of the standard cable manager, and pull it straight out from the
studs on the front of the chassis.
To install the standard cable manager (see Figure 113 on page 307):
1. Position the standard cable manager on the studs on the lower front of the chassis.
2. Insert the nuts on the corners in the standard cable manager onto the studs on the
chassis.
3. Using a 7/16-in. (11 mm) nut driver, tighten the nuts securely.
To use a system console to configure and manage the Routing Engine, connect it to the
CONSOLE port on the Routing Engine. To use a laptop, modem, or other auxiliary device,
connect it to the AUX port on the Routing Engine. Both ports accept a cable with an RJ-45
connector. One RJ-45/DB-9 cable is provided with the router. If you want to connect a
device to both ports, you must supply another cable.
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Press the tab on the connector, and pull the connector straight out of the port.
4. Plug the RJ-45 end of the replacement serial cable into the CONSOLE or AUX port.
Figure 114 on page 308 shows the external device ports on the Routing Engine.
5. Plug the female DB-9 end into the console or auxiliary device's serial port.
• Routing Engine Interface Cable and Wire Specifications for MX Series Routers on
page 134
One Ethernet cable with RJ-45 connectors is provided with the router. To replace the
cable connected to the ETHERNET port:
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Press the tab on the connector, and pull the connector straight out of the port.
Figure 115 on page 309 shows the connector.
4. Plug one end of the replacement cable into the ETHERNET port. Figure 116 on page 309
shows the port.
5. Plug the other end of the cable into the network device.
Up to eight AS MLCs can be installed vertically in the front of the MX960 router. The AS
MLCs are hot-insertable and hot-removable. An empty AS MLC weighs 10.5 lb (4.76 kg).
A fully configured AS MLC can weigh up to 15.27 lb (6.93 kg). Be prepared to accept its
full weight.
1. Have ready a replacement AS MLC or an AS MLC blank panel and an antistatic mat
for the AS MLC.
2. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
• Press and hold the AS MLC online/offline button. The green OK LED next to the
button begins to blink. Hold the button down until the LED goes out. The
online/offline button for each AS MLC is located directly above it on the craft
interface.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
NOTE: The slot number corresponds to the lowest numbered slot for
which the AS MLC is installed.
4. Simultaneously turn both the ejector handles counterclockwise to unseat the AS MLC.
5. Grasp the handles, and slide the AS MLC straight out of the card cage halfway.
6. Place one hand around the front of the AS MLC (the modular card housing) and the
other hand under it to support it. Slide the AS MLC completely out of the chassis, and
place it on the antistatic mat or in the electrostatic bag.
When the AS MLC is out of the chassis, do not hold it by the ejector handles,
bus bars, or edge connectors. They cannot support its weight.
Do not stack AS MLCs on top of one another after removal. Place each
one individually in an electrostatic bag or on its own antistatic mat on a
flat, stable surface.
7. If necessary, remove each installed AS MSC and AS MXC from the AS MLC.
8. After you remove each modular card, immediately place it on an antistatic mat or in
an electrostatic bag.
9. If you are not reinstalling an AS MLC into the emptied slots within a short time, install
a blank AS MLC panel over each slot to maintain proper airflow in the card cage.
0
MASTER
1 YELLOWALARM
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE REDALARM
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0
g006679
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
3. Take the AS MSC and AS MXC (the modular cards) to be installed in the AS MLC out
of its electrostatic bag. The AS MSC must be inserted in the top slot and the AS MXC
in the bottom slot.
4. Install the AS MSC and AS MXC into the appropriate slot on the AS MLC.
5. Locate the slots in the card cage in which you plan to install the AS MLC.
7. Lift the AS MLC into place, and carefully align the sides of the AS MLC with the guides
inside the card cage.
CAUTION: When the AS MLC is out of the chassis, do not hold it by the
ejector handles, bus bars, or edge connectors. They cannot support its
weight.
8. Slide the AS MLC all the way into the card cage until you feel resistance.
9. Grasp both ejector handles, and rotate them clockwise simultaneously until the AS
MLC is fully seated.
10. Use one of the following methods to bring the AS MLC online:
• Press and hold the AS MLC online/offline button until the green OK LED next to the
button lights steadily, in about 5 seconds. The LEDs and online/offline button for
each AS MLC are located directly above it on the craft interface.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
CAUTION: After the OK LED lights steadily, wait at least 30 seconds before
removing the AS MLC again, removing an AS MLC from a different slot, or
inserting an AS MLC in a different slot.
You can also verify correct AS MLC and AS MSC or AS MXC functioning by issuing the
show chassis fpc and show chassis fpc pic-status.
0
MASTER
1 YELLOWALARM
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE REDALARM
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0
g006678
The AS MSCs are located in the AS MLCs installed in the front of the router. An AS MSC
weighs 1.4 lb (0.6 kg).
1. Place an electrostatic bag or antistatic mat on a flat, stable surface to receive the AS
MSC.
2. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
• Press its online/offline button. Use a narrow-ended tool that fits inside the opening
that leads to the button. Press and hold the button until the AS MSC LED goes out
(about 5 seconds).
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
4. Slide the AS MSC out of the AS MLC card carrier by pulling the handles, and place it
in the electrostatic bag or on the antistatic mat.
5. If you are not reinstalling an AS MSC into the emptied AS MSC slot within a short time,
install a blank AS MSC panel over the slot to maintain proper airflow in the AS MLC
card cage.
g006675
See Also • MX960 Application Services Modular Storage Card Description on page 54
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Align the notches in the connector at the rear of the AS MSC with the notches in the
AS MSC slot (slot 0—the top slot in the AS MLC ), and then slide the AS MSC in until
it lodges firmly in the AS MLC.
CAUTION: Slide the AS MSC straight into the slot to avoid damaging the
components on the bottom of the AS MSC.
• Press the AS MSC offline/online button until the LED light turns green.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
The normal functioning status LED confirms that the AS MSC is online. You can also
verify correct AS MSC functioning by issuing the show chassis fpc pic-status command..
g006674
See Also • MX960 Application Services Modular Storage Card Description on page 54
The AS MXCs are located in the AS MLCs installed in the front of the router. An AS MXC
weighs less than 2 lb (0.9 kg).
1. Place an electrostatic bag or antistatic mat on a flat, stable surface to receive the AS
MXC.
2. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
• Press its online/offline button. Use a narrow-ended tool that fits inside the opening
that leads to the button. Press and hold the button until the AS MXC LED goes out
(about 5 seconds).
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
5. Slide the AS MXC out of the AS MLC card carrier by pulling the handles, and place it
in the electrostatic bag or on the antistatic mat.
6. If you are not reinstalling an AS MXC into the emptied AS MXC slot within a short time,
install a blank AS MXC panel over the slot to maintain proper airflow in the AS MLC
card cage.
g006677
See Also • MX960 Application Services Modular Processing Card Description on page 55
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Align the notches in the connector at the rear of the AS MXC with the notches in the
AS MXC slot (slot 1—the bottom slot in the AS MLC), and then slide the AS MXC in
until it lodges firmly in the AS MLC.
CAUTION: Slide the AS MXC straight into the slot to avoid damaging the
components on the bottom of the AS MXC.
• Press the AS MXC offline/online button until the LED light turns green.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
The normal functioning status LED confirms that the AS MXC is online. You can also
verify correct AS MXC functioning by issuing the show chassis fpc pic-status command.
g006676
CAUTION: Do not run the router for more than a few minutes without the air
filter in place.
CAUTION: Always keep the air filter in place while the router is operating,
except during replacement. Because the fans are very powerful, they could
pull small bits of wire or other materials into the router through the unfiltered
air intake. This could damage the router components.
To remove the normal-capacity air filter tray, use the following procedure.
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Unwrap any cables on the standard cable manager and remove the cables from the
tray. Arrange the cables so that they do not block the front of the cable manager and
tray, and secure them with temporary fasteners so that they are not supporting their
own weight as they hang from the connector.
NOTE: Removing the cables from the extended cable manager is not
necessary to access the air filter.
CAUTION: Do not let fiber-optic cable hang free from the connector. Do
not allow fastened loops of cable to dangle, which stresses the cable at
the fastening point.
CAUTION: Do not run the router for more than two minutes without the
air filter in place.
3. Simultaneously pull the two releases labeled PULL on the standard cable manager.
Lift it up and outward to lock it in place to access the air filter.
4. Pull the filter tray release on both sides of the filter tray.
5. Slide the air filter tray out of the chassis as shown in Figure 123 on page 322.
Figure 123: Removing the Normal-Capacity Air Filter Tray from the Chassis
g006063
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
4. Insert the air filter tray into the chassis by sliding it straight into the chassis until it
stops.
To remove the upper or lower fan tray (see Figure 125 on page 325 and
Figure 126 on page 326):
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Reposition the standard cable manager before removing the lower front fan tray:
NOTE: This step is not required for the extended cable manager.
a. Unwrap any cables on the standard cable manager and remove the cables from
the tray. Arrange the cables so that they do not block the front of the cable manager
and tray, and secure them with temporary fasteners so that they are not supporting
their own weight as they hang from the connector.
b. Simultaneously pull the two releases labelled PULL on the cable manager. Lift it
up and outward to lock it in place.
3. Loosen the captive screw on each side of the fan tray faceplate.
4. Grasp both sides of the fan tray, and pull it out approximately 1 to 3 inches.
WARNING: To avoid injury, keep tools and your fingers away from the fans
as you slide the fan module out of the chassis. The fans might still be
spinning.
6. When the fans stop spinning, press on the two latches located on the inside of the
fan tray.
7. Place one hand under the fan tray to support it, and pull the fan tray completely out
of the chassis.
0
MASTER
1 YELL
OW ALAR
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE M RED ALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
g004042
0
MASTER
1 YELL
OW ALAR
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE M RED ALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
g004044
See Also • Preventing Electrostatic Discharge Damage to an MX960 Router
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Grasp the fan tray on each side, and insert it straight into the chassis. Note the correct
orientation by the "this side up" label on the top surface of the fan tray.
3. Tighten the captive screws on each side of the fan tray faceplate to secure it in the
chassis.
0
MASTER
1 YELL
OW ALAR
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE M RED ALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
g004043
0
MASTER
1 YELL
OW ALAR
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE M RED ALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
g004045
See Also • Preventing Electrostatic Discharge Damage to an MX960 Router
CAUTION: Before you replace a Routing Engine, you must take the host
subsystem offline. If there is only one host subsystem, taking the host
subsystem offline shuts down the router.
To remove a Routing Engine from an SCB (see Figure 129 on page 331):
3. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
5. Loosen the captive screws on the top and bottom of the Routing Engine.
7. Grasp the Routing Engine by the ejector handles, and slide it about halfway out of the
chassis.
8. Place one hand underneath the Routing Engine to support it, and slide it completely
out of the chassis.
0
MASTER
1 YELL
OW ALAR
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE M RED ALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0
OK/FAIL 1 0 1
0
HDD
ONLIN E
MASTE R
OFFLIN E
ONLINE /
RESET
USB
AUX
CONSOL E
ETHERNE T
g004050
• Routing Engine Interface Cable and Wire Specifications for MX Series Routers on
page 134
1. Ensure that the ejector handles are not in the locked position. If necessary, flip the
ejector handles outward.
3. Carefully align the sides of the Routing Engine with the guides inside the opening on
the SCB.
4. Slide the Routing Engine into the SCB until you feel resistance, and then press the
Routing Engine's faceplate until it engages the connectors.
5. Press both of the ejector handles inward to seat the Routing Engine.
6. Tighten the captive screws on the top and bottom of the Routing Engine.
After the Routing Engine boots, verify that it is installed correctly by checking the FAIL,
RE0, and RE1 LEDs on the craft interface. If the router is operational and the Routing
Engine is functioning properly, the green ONLINE LED lights steadily. If the red FAIL LED
lights steadily instead, remove and install the Routing Engine again. If the red FAIL LED
still lights steadily, the Routing Engine is not functioning properly. Contact your customer
support representative.
To check the status of the Routing Engine, use the CLI command:
For more information about using the CLI, see the Junos OS documentation.
0
MASTER
1 YELL
OW ALAR
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE M RED ALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0
OK/FAIL 1 0 1
0
HDD
ONLIN E
MASTE R
OFFLIN E
ONLINE /
RESET
USB
AUX
CONSOL E
ETHERNE T
g004051
• Routing Engine Interface Cable and Wire Specifications for MX Series Routers on
page 134
Each RE-S-1800 Routing Engine supports two solid-state drives (SSD) specified by
Juniper Networks. The RE-S-1800 ships with one SSD installed in the slot labeled SATA
SSD 1. The spare SSD is Juniper part number SSD-32G-RE-S. Figure 131 on page 334 shows
the arrangement of storage drive slots on a RE-S-1800 Routing Engine.
g006039
Extractor Console USB Status LEDs Extractor
clip port port clip
The following drive has been verified to work in the RE-S-1800 Routing Engine:
• SSD-32G-RE-S
a. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist, and
connect the strap to an ESD point on the appliance.
For more information about ESD, see Preventing Electrostatic Discharge Damage
in the hardware guide for your router.
b. Unfasten the thumbscrew that secures the access door in front of the storage drive
slots, and open the door.
a. Carefully align the sides of the drive with the guides in the slot.
b. Slide the drive into the slot until you feel resistance, carefully ensuring that it is
correctly aligned.
c. Close the access door and tighten the thumbscrew to secure the door.
Each RE-S-X6-64G Routing Engine supports two solid-state drives (SSD) specified by
Juniper Networks. The RE-S-X6-64G ships with two SSDs installed in the slot labeled
DISK1 and DISK2. Figure 132 on page 336 shows the arrangement of storage drive slots on
a RE-S-X6-64G Routing Engine.
Replacing an SSD drive in a RE-S-X6-64G Routing Engine consists of the following two
stages:
The following drive has been verified to work in the RE-S-X6-64G Routing Engine:
a. Make sure that there is no VMHost %d Boot from alternate disk alarm in the output:
a. Make sure that the router is booted up and running from an image from disk1.
Back up the currently running vmhost and Junos OS on disk1 to ensure that both
disk1 and disk2 have the same version of vmhost and Junos OS:
c. Check for the presence of the VMHost %d Boot from alternate disk alarm in the
output:
a. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist, and connect the strap to an ESD
point on the appliance.
For more information about ESD, see Preventing Electrostatic Discharge Damage
in the hardware guide for your router.
b. Unfasten the thumbscrew that secures the access door in front of the storage drive
slots, and open the door.
4. Reinstall an SSD:
a. Carefully align the sides of the drive with the guides in the slot.
b. Slide the drive into the slot until you feel resistance, carefully ensuring that it is
correctly aligned.
c. Close the access door and tighten the thumbscrew to secure the door.
1. Insert the USB disk in the USB slot on the Routing Engine.
2. After the Routing Engine boots from the USB, press y when you are prompted
to confirm Install vmhost and Junos software on Primary and Secondary disk
[y/N? on the console.
1. Set up the PXEBoot server. See Copying VM Host Installation Package to the
PXE Boot Server.
3. During the boot, when you see the message Press Esc for boot options press Esc
key to enter into the BIOS menu boot options.
After the Esc key is pressed, Esc is pressed. Go to boot options. is displayed on
the screen.
4. Using Up or Down arrow keys, navigate to Boot Manager and press the Enter
key.
5. Using Up or Down arrow keys, navigate through the EFI boot devices listed and
select EFI Network 0 for IPv4 to boot from the PXEboot server and press the
Enter key.
7. After the Routing Engine boots, press y when you are prompted to confirm Install
vmhost and Junos software on Primary and Secondary disk [y/N? on the console.
Copying vmhost and Junos OS from an USB disk when both the SSDs are replaced
together:
NOTE: To prepare a bootable USB disk, see Creating an Emergency Boot Device
for RE-MX-X6, RE-MX-X8 and RE-PTX-X8 Routing Engines.
1. Insert the USB disk in the USB slot on the Routing Engine.
2. After the Routing Engine boots from the USB, press y when you are prompted to
confirm Install vmhost and Junos software on Primary and Secondary disk [y/N]? on
the console.
3. After the installation is completed, press y when prompted to confirm Reboot now?
[y/N]? to reboot from the SSD disk.
Copying vmhost and Junos OS to the SSDs from the PXEBoot server:
1. Set up the PXEBoot server. See Copying VM Host Installation Package to the PXE Boot
Server.
3. During the boot, when you see the message Press Esc for boot options press Esc key
to enter into the BIOS menu boot options.
After the Esc key is pressed, Esc is pressed. Go to boot options. is displayed on the
screen.
4. Using Up or Down arrow keys, navigate to Boot Manager and press the Enter key.
5. Using Up or Down arrow keys, navigate through the EFI boot devices listed and select
EFI Network 0 for IPv4 to boot from the PXEboot server and press the Enter key.
7. After the Routing Engine boots, press y when you are prompted to confirm Install
vmhost and Junos software on Primary and Secondary disk [y/N]? on the console.
8. After the installation is completed, press y when prompted to confirm Reboot now?
[y/N]? to reboot from the SSD disk.
b. The router boots from disk1 if disk2 is replaced. To be able to boot from disk2:
The router boots from disk2 if disk1 is replaced. To be able to boot from disk1:
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Press the tab on the connector, and pull the connector straight out of the port.
Figure 115 on page 309 shows the connector.
4. Plug one end of the replacement cable into the ETHERNET port. Figure 116 on page 309
shows the port.
5. Plug the other end of the cable into the network device.
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Press the tab on the connector, and pull the connector straight out of the port.
4. Plug the RJ-45 end of the replacement serial cable into the CONSOLE or AUX port.
Figure 114 on page 308 shows the external device ports on the Routing Engine.
5. Plug the female DB-9 end into the console or auxiliary device's serial port.
• Routing Engine Interface Cable and Wire Specifications for MX Series Routers on
page 134
A redundant host subsystem consists of a master Routing Engine (RE0) and a backup
Routing Engine (RE1). To upgrade the host subsystem to use the RE-S-X6-64G Routing
Engine, you must first uninstall the backup Routing Engine and install the RE-S-X6-64G
Routing Engine, which then becomes the backup Routing Engine. You then switch over
this backup Routing Engine to make it the master Routing Engine. Replace the other
Routing Engine and configure it as the backup Routing Engine.
Ensure that the Switch Control Board in the chassis is SCBE2 because the RE-S-X6-64G
Routing Engine is not compatible with the Switch Control Boards SCB or SCBE. To upgrade
the Switch Control Board to SCBE2, see Upgrading an MX240 to Use the SCBE2-MX,
Upgrading an MX480 to Use the SCBE2-MXor “Upgrading an MX960 to Use the SCBE2-MX”
on page 430, depending on the chassis on which the Routing Engine is being upgraded.
NOTE: Save the router configuration before proceeding with the Routing
Engine upgrade.
NOTE: Nonstop active routing (NSR) and graceful Routing Engine switchover
(GRES) are not supported during the upgrade and they must be temporarily
disabled. Disable NSR by removing the nonstop-routing statement from the
[edit routing-options] hierarchy level and by removing the graceful-switchover
statement from the [edit chassis redundancy] hierarchy level .
3. Verifying and Configuring the Upgraded Routing Engine as the Master on page 348
4. Verifying and Configuring the Upgraded Routing Engine as the Backup on page 348
1. On the external management device connected to the Routing Engine, shut down the
host subsystem by using the request system power-off command.
2. Wait until a message appears on the console confirming that the operating system
has halted.
5. Verify that the Routing Engine LEDs are off. Loosen the captive screws on the top and
bottom of the Routing Engine.
6. Grasp the Routing Engine by the ejector handles, and slide it about halfway out of the
chassis.
7. Place one hand underneath the Routing Engine to support it, and slide it completely
out of the chassis. Place the Routing Engine on the antistatic mat.
NOTE: To maintain proper airflow through the chassis, do not leave an SCB
installed in the chassis without a Routing Engine for extended periods of time.
If a Routing Engine is removed, a replacement Routing Engine should be
installed as soon as possible.
0
MASTER
1 YELL
OW ALAR
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE M RED ALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0
OK/FAIL 1 0 1
0
HDD
ONLIN E
MASTE R
OFFLIN E
ONLINE /
RESET
USB
AUX
CONSOL E
ETHERNE T
g004050
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Ensure that the ejector handles are not in the locked position. If necessary, flip the
ejector handles outward.
3. Place one hand underneath the Routing Engine to support it and carefully align the
sides of the Routing Engine with the guides inside the opening on the Switch Control
Board SCBE2.
4. Slide the Routing Engine into the SCBE2 until you feel resistance, and then press the
Routing Engine's faceplate until it engages the connectors.
5. Press both of the ejector handles inward to seat the Routing Engine. Tighten the
captive screws on the top and bottom of the Routing Engine.
6. Connect the management device cables to the Routing Engine. After the Routing
Engine is installed, the ONLINE LED starts blinking green slowly.
7. Replace the former master Routing Engine, RE0, with the Routing Engine RE-S-X6-64G.
The Routing Engine might require several minutes to boot. After the Routing Engine boots,
verify that it is installed correctly by checking the FAIL, RE0, and RE1 LEDs on the craft
interface. If the router is operational and the Routing Engine is functioning properly, the
green ONLINE LED on the Routing Engine lights steadily. If the red FAIL LED on the Routing
Engine lights steadily instead, remove and install the Routing Engine again. If the red FAIL
LED still lights steadily, the Routing Engine is not functioning properly. Contact your
customer support representative.
0
MASTER
1 YELL
OW ALAR
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE M RED ALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
OK/FAIL
HDD
ONLIN E
MASTE R
OFFLIN E
ONLINE /
RESET
USB
AUX
CONSOL E
ETHERNE T
g004051
1. Verify that the SCBE2 and RE-S-X6-64G Routing Engine are online by issuing the
show chassis hardware command.
2. After you install the RE-S-X6-64G Routing Engine into the SCBE2, the Routing Engine
gets automatically powered on and comes up in amnesiac mode as it is loaded with
factory defaults. After the Routing Engine comes up in amnesiac mode, load the base
configuration and commit.
3. Configure the backup Routing Engine by using the commit synchronize command to
copy the configuration to the backup Routing Engine.
4. Use the request chassis routing-engine master switch command to make the Routing
Engine RE-S-X6-64G (RE1) the master Routing Engine. All FPCs reboot after this step.
2. Use the commit synchronize command to copy the active configuration from the
master Routing Engine to the backup Routing Engine.
In a nonredundant host subsystem, only one Routing Engine and one Switch Control
Board are present in the chassis. When you are upgrading the Routing Engine, taking the
host subsystem offline shuts down the router. To upgrade the host subsystem with the
RE-S-X6-64G Routing Engine, you must uninstall the existing Routing Engine and install
the RE-S-X6-64G Routing Engine. Ensure that the Switch Control Board in the chassis
is SCBE2 because the RE-S-X6-64G Routing Engine is not compatible with the Switch
Control Boards SCB or SCBE. To upgrade the Switch Control Board to SCBE2, see
Upgrading an MX240 to Use the SCBE2-MX, Upgrading an MX480 to Use the SCBE2-MXor
“Upgrading an MX960 to Use the SCBE2-MX” on page 430, depending on the chassis on
which the Routing Engine is being upgraded. .
NOTE: Save the router configuration before proceeding with the Routing
Engine upgrade.
1. On the external management device connected to the Routing Engine, shut down the
host subsystem by using the request system power-off command.
2. Wait until a message appears on the console confirming that the operating system
has halted.
4. Place an electrostatic bag or antistatic mat on a flat, stable surface. Attach an ESD
grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the ESD points on
the chassis.
5. Verify that the Routing Engine LEDs are off. Loosen the captive screws on the top and
bottom of the Routing Engine.
6. Grasp the Routing Engine by the ejector handles, and slide it about halfway out of the
chassis.
7. Place one hand underneath the Routing Engine to support it, and slide it completely
out of the chassis. Place the Routing Engine on the antistatic mat.
NOTE: To maintain proper airflow through the chassis, do not leave an SCB
installed in the chassis without a Routing Engine for extended periods of time.
If a Routing Engine is removed, a replacement Routing Engine should be
installed as soon as possible.
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Ensure that the ejector handles are not in the locked position. If necessary, flip the
ejector handles outward.
3. Place one hand underneath the Routing Engine to support it and carefully align the
sides of the Routing Engine with the guides inside the opening on the SCBE2.
4. Slide the Routing Engine into the SCBE2 until you feel resistance, and then press the
Routing Engine's faceplate until it engages the connectors.
5. Press both of the ejector handles inward to seat the Routing Engine. Tighten the
captive screws on the top and bottom of the Routing Engine.
6. Connect the management device cables to the Routing Engine. After the Routing
Engine is installed, the ONLINE LED starts blinking green slowly.
7. Verify that the SCBE2 and RE-S-X6-64G Routing Engine are online by issuing the
show chassis hardware command.
8. After you install the RE-S-X6-64G Routing Engine into the SCBE2, the Routing Engine
gets automatically powered on and comes up in amnesiac mode as it is loaded with
factory defaults. After the Routing Engine comes up in amnesiac mode, load the base
configuration and commit.
The Routing Engine might require several minutes to boot. After the Routing Engine boots,
verify that it is installed correctly by checking the FAIL, RE0, and RE1 LEDs on the craft
interface. If the router is operational and the Routing Engine is functioning properly, the
green ONLINE LED on the Routing Engine lights steadily. If the red FAIL LED lights steadily
instead, remove the Routing Engine and reinstall it. If the red FAIL LED on the Routing
Engine still lights steadily, the Routing Engine is not functioning properly. Contact your
customer support representative.
1. Have ready a replacement DPC or DPC blank panel and an antistatic mat for the DPC.
Also have ready rubber safety caps for each DPC you are removing that uses an optical
interface.
2. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
3. Label the cables connected to each port on the DPC so that you can later reconnect
the cables to the correct ports.
• Press and hold the corresponding DPC online button on the craft interface. The
green OK LED next to the button begins to blink. Hold the button down until the LED
goes off.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
6. Immediately cover each optical transceiver and the end of each fiber-optic cable with
a rubber safety cap.
7. Arrange the disconnected cables in the standard or extended cable manager to prevent
the cables from developing stress points.
8. Simultaneously turn both of the ejector handles counterclockwise to unseat the DPC.
9. Grasp the handles, and slide the DPC straight out of the card cage halfway.
10. Place one hand around the front of the DPC and the other hand under it to support it.
Slide the DPC completely out of the chassis, and place it on the antistatic mat or in
the electrostatic bag.
When the DPC is out of the chassis, do not hold it by the ejector handles,
bus bars, or edge connectors. They cannot support its weight.
Do not stack DPCs on top of one another after removal. Place each one
individually in an electrostatic bag or on its own antistatic mat on a flat,
stable surface.
11. If you are not reinstalling a DPC into the emptied DPC slot within a short time, install
a blank DPC panel over the slot to maintain proper airflow in the DPC card cage.
CAUTION: After removing a DPC from the chassis, wait at least 30 seconds
before reinserting it, removing a DPC from a different slot, or inserting a
DPC into a different slot.
0
MASTER
1 YELL
OW ALAR
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE M RED ALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
OK/FAIL 1 0
1 0
0/0 0/5 2/0 2/5
1 0 1 0 0
1
1/0 1/5
3/0 3/5
g004052
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Place the DPC on an antistatic mat, or remove it from its electrostatic bag.
4. Verify that each fiber-optic transceiver is covered with a rubber safety cap. If it does
not, cover the transceiver with a safety cap.
6. Lift the DPC into place, and carefully align the sides of the DPC with the guides inside
the card cage.
7. Slide the DPC all the way into the card cage until you feel resistance.
8. Grasp both ejector handles, and rotate them clockwise simultaneously until the DPC
is fully seated.
9. Remove the rubber safety cap from each fiber-optic transceiver and cable.
10. Insert the cables into the cable connector ports on each DPC (see
Figure 94 on page 268).
11. Arrange the cable in the standard or extended cable manager to prevent it from
dislodging or developing stress points. Secure the cable so that it is not supporting its
own weight as it hangs to the floor. Place excess cable out of the way in a neatly coiled
loop. Placing fasteners on the loop helps to maintain its shape.
CAUTION: Do not let fiber-optic cables hang free from the connector. Do
not allow the fastened loops of a cable to dangle, which stresses the cable
at the fastening point.
12. Use one of the following methods to bring the DPC online:
• Press and hold the corresponding DPC online button on the craft interface until the
green OK LED next to the button lights steadily, in about 5 seconds.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
CAUTION: After the OK LED turns green, wait at least 30 seconds before
removing the DPC again, removing a DPC from a different slot, or inserting
a DPC in a different slot.
You can also verify that the DPC is functioning correctly by issuing the show chassis fpc
and show chassis fpc pic-status commands.
0
MASTER
1 YELL
OW ALAR
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE M RED ALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
OK/FAIL 1 0
1 0
0/0 0/5 2/0 2/5
1 0 1 0 0
1
1/0 1/5
3/0 3/5
g004053
An FPC takes up two DPC slots on the MX960 router. Up to six FPCs can be installed
vertically in the front of the MX960 router. The FPCs are hot-insertable and hot-removable.
An empty FPC3 weighs 14 lb (6.5 kg). A fully configured FPC can weigh up to 18 lb (8.2 kg).
Be prepared to accept its full weight.
1. Have ready a replacement FPC or FPC blank panel and an antistatic mat for the FPC.
Also have ready rubber safety caps for each PIC using an optical interface on the FPC
that you are removing.
2. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
3. Label the cables connected to each PIC on the FPC so that you can later reconnect
the cables to the correct PICs.
• Press and hold the FPC online/offline button. The green OK LED next to the button
begins to blink. Hold the button down until the LED goes out. The LEDs and
online/offline button for each FPC are located directly above it on the craft interface.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
NOTE: The slot number corresponds to the lowest numbered slot for
which the FPC is installed.
6. If a PIC uses fiber-optic cable, immediately cover each transceiver and the end of each
cable with a rubber safety cap. Arrange the disconnected cables in the cable manager
to prevent the cables from developing stress points.
7. Simultaneously turn both the ejector handles counterclockwise to unseat the FPC.
8. Grasp the handles, and slide the FPC straight out of the card cage halfway.
9. Place one hand around the front of the FPC (the PIC housing) and the other hand
under it to support it. Slide the FPC completely out of the chassis, and place it on the
antistatic mat or in the electrostatic bag.
When the FPC is out of the chassis, do not hold it by the ejector handles,
bus bars, or edge connectors. They cannot support its weight.
Do not stack FPCs on top of one another after removal. Place each one
individually in an electrostatic bag or on its own antistatic mat on a flat,
stable surface.
11. After you remove each PIC, immediately place it on an antistatic mat or in an
electrostatic bag.
12. If you are not reinstalling an FPC into the emptied DPC slots within a short time, install
a blank DPC panel over each slot to maintain proper airflow in the card cage.
0
MASTER
1 YELLOW
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE ALAR
M REDALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
g004407
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
3. Take each PIC to be installed in the replacement FPC out of its electrostatic bag, and
identify the slot on the FPC where it will be connected.
4. Verify that each fiber-optic PIC has a rubber safety cap covering the PIC transceiver.
If it does not, cover the transceiver with a safety cap.
6. Locate the two slots in the card cage in which you plan to install the FPC.
8. Lift the FPC into place, and carefully align the sides of the FPC with the guides inside
the card cage.
CAUTION: When the FPC is out of the chassis, do not hold it by the ejector
handles, bus bars, or edge connectors. They cannot support its weight.
9. Slide the FPC all the way into the card cage until you feel resistance.
10. Grasp both ejector handles, and rotate them clockwise simultaneously until the FPC
is fully seated.
11. If any of the PICs on the FPC connect to fiber-optic cable, remove the rubber safety
cap from each transceiver and cable.
12. Insert the appropriate cable into the cable connector ports on each PIC on the FPC.
13. Arrange the cable in the standard or extended cable manager to prevent it from
dislodging or developing stress points. Secure the cable so that it is not supporting its
own weight as it hangs to the floor. Place excess cable out of the way in a neatly coiled
loop. Placing fasteners on the loop helps to maintain its shape.
CAUTION: Do not let fiber-optic cables hang free from the connector. Do
not allow the fastened loops of a cable to dangle, which stresses the cable
at the fastening point.
14. Use one of the following methods to bring the FPC online:
• Press and hold the FPC online/offline button until the green OK LED next to the
button lights steadily, in about 5 seconds. The LEDs and online/offline button for
each FPC are located directly above it on the craft interface.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
CAUTION: After the OK LED lights steadily, wait at least 30 seconds before
removing the FPC again, removing an FPC from a different slot, or inserting
an FPC in a different slot.
You can also verify correct FPC and PIC functioning by issuing the show chassis fpc and
show chassis fpc pic-status commands described in “Maintaining MX960 FPCs” on page 453
and “Maintaining MX960 PICs” on page 464.
0
MASTER
1 YELLOW
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE ALAR
M REDALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
g004404
The MICs are located in the MPCs installed in the front of the router. A MIC weighs less
than 2 lb (0.9 kg).
To remove a MIC (see Figure 149 on page 366 and Figure 150 on page 367):
1. Place an electrostatic bag or antistatic mat on a flat, stable surface to receive the
MIC. If the MIC connects to fiber-optic cable, have ready a rubber safety cap for each
transceiver and cable.
2. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
• Press its online/offline button. Use a narrow-ended tool that fits inside the opening
that leads to the button. Press the button until the MIC OK/FAIL LED goes off.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
4. Label the cables connected to the MIC so that you can later reconnect each cable to
the correct MIC.
5. Disconnect the cables from the MIC. If the MIC uses fiber-optic cable, immediately
cover each transceiver and the end of each cable with a rubber safety cap.
6. Arrange the cable to prevent it from dislodging or developing stress points. Secure
the cable so that it is not supporting its own weight as it hangs to the floor. Place
excess cable out of the way in a neatly coiled loop.
7. On the MPC, pull the ejector lever that is adjacent to the MIC you are removing away
from the MPC faceplate. This disconnects the MIC from the MPC.
NOTE: To remove a dual-wide MIC that takes up both MIC slots, you must
pull both ejector levers away from the MPC faceplate.
8. Grasp the handles on the MIC faceplate, and slide the MIC out of the MPC card carrier.
Place it in the electrostatic bag or on the antistatic mat.
9. If you are not reinstalling a MIC into the emptied MIC slot within a short time, install
a blank MIC panel over the slot to maintain proper airflow in the MPC card cage.
g004926
0
MASTER
1 YELLOW ALARM
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE RED ALARM
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
Ejector
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
Ejector
g005053
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. If you have used a dual-wide MIC and are now replacing it with two “single” MICs,
install the septum (see Figure 96 on page 272):
a. Place the MPC on a flat surface (if necessary, remove the MPC from the router as
described in “Removing an MX960 MPC” on page 374).
b. Position the septum in the center of the MPC so that it lines up with holes labeled
S on the top of the MPC.
c. Insert a screw into each of the two holes labeled S, and then tighten completely.
d. On the bottom of the MPC, insert a screw into each of the four holes labeled S, and
then tighten completely.
g005041
3. If the MIC uses fiber-optic cable, verify that a rubber safety cap is over each transceiver
on the faceplate. Install a cap if necessary.
4. On the MPC, pull the ejector lever that is adjacent to the MIC you are installing away
from the MPC faceplate.
5. Align the rear of the MIC with the guides located at the corners of the MIC slot.
6. Slide the MIC into the MPC until it is firmly seated in the MPC.
CAUTION: Slide the MIC straight into the slot to avoid damaging the
components on the MIC.
7. Verify that the ejector lever is engaged by pushing it towards the MPC faceplate.
8. If the MIC uses fiber-optic cable, remove the rubber safety cap from each transceiver
and the end of each cable.
9. Insert the appropriate cables into the cable connectors on the MIC.
10. Arrange each cable to prevent the cable from dislodging or developing stress points.
Secure the cable so that it is not supporting its own weight as it hangs to the floor.
Place excess cable out of the way in a neatly coiled loop.
CAUTION: Do not let fiber-optic cables hang free from the connector. Do
not allow the fastened loops of a cable to dangle, which stresses the cable
at the fastening point.
11. Use one of the following methods to bring the MIC online:
• Press its online/offline button. Use a narrow-ended tool that fits inside the opening
that leads to the button. Press the button until the MIC OK/FAIL LED lights green.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
The normal functioning status LED confirms that the MIC is online. You can also verify
correct MIC functioning by issuing the show chassis fpc pic-status command described
in “Maintaining MX960 MICs” on page 460.
g004924
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
a. Place the MPC on a flat surface (if necessary, remove the MPC from the router as
described in “Removing an MX960 MPC” on page 374).
g005040
MPC
3. If the MIC uses fiber-optic cable, verify that a rubber safety cap is over each transceiver
on the faceplate. Install a cap if necessary.
4. Pull the ejector lever above both MIC slots away from the router.
5. Align the rear of the MIC with the guides located at the corners of the MIC slot.
6. Slide the MIC into the MIC slot until it is firmly seated in the chassis.
CAUTION: Slide the MIC straight into the slot to avoid damaging the
components on the MIC.
7. Verify that the ejector levers are engaged by pushing them toward the router.
8. If the MIC uses fiber-optic cable, remove the rubber safety cap from each transceiver
and the end of each cable.
9. Insert the appropriate cables into the cable connectors on the MIC.
10. Arrange each cable to prevent the cable from dislodging or developing stress points.
Secure the cable so that it is not supporting its own weight as it hangs to the floor.
Place excess cable out of the way in a neatly coiled loop.
CAUTION: Do not let fiber-optic cables hang free from the connector. Do
not allow the fastened loops of a cable to dangle, which stresses the cable
at the fastening point.
11. Use one of the following methods to bring the MIC online:
• Press its online/offline button. Use a narrow-ended tool that fits inside the opening
that leads to the button. Press the button until the MIC OK/FAIL LED lights green.
The normal functioning status LED confirms that the MIC is online. You can also verify
correct MIC functioning by issuing the show chassis fpc pic-status command described
in “Maintaining MX960 MICs” on page 460.
0
MASTER
1 YELLOW ALARM
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE RED ALARM
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
Dual-wide MIC
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
g005052
An MPC installs vertically in the front of the router. The MPCs are hot-insertable and
hot-removable. A fully configured MPC can weigh up to 18.35 lb (8.3 kg). Be prepared to
accept its full weight.
1. Have ready a replacement MPC or DPC blank panel and an antistatic mat for the MPC.
Also have ready rubber safety caps for each MIC using an optical interface on the MPC
that you are removing.
2. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
3. Label the cables connected to each MIC on the MPC so that you can later reconnect
the cables to the correct MICs.
• Press and hold the corresponding online button on the craft interface. The green
OK/FAIL LED next to the button begins to blink. Hold the button down until the LED
goes off.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
6. If a MIC uses fiber-optic cable, immediately cover each transceiver and the end of
each cable with a rubber safety cap.
7. Arrange the disconnected cables in the cable manager to prevent the cables from
developing stress points.
8. Simultaneously turn both the ejector handles counterclockwise to unseat the MPC.
9. Grasp the handles, and slide the MPC straight out of the card cage halfway.
10. Place one hand around the front of the MPC (the MIC housing) and the other hand
under it to support it. Slide the MPC completely out of the chassis, and place it on the
antistatic mat or in the electrostatic bag.
When the MPC is out of the chassis, do not hold it by the ejector handles,
bus bars, or edge connectors. They cannot support its weight.
Do not stack MPCs on top of one another after removal. Place each one
individually in an electrostatic bag or on its own antistatic mat on a flat,
stable surface.
12. After you remove each MIC, immediately place it on an antistatic mat or in an
electrostatic bag.
13. If you are not reinstalling an MPC into the emptied line card slots within a short time,
install a blank DPC panel over each slot to maintain proper airflow in the card cage.
0
MASTER
1 YELLOW ALARM
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE RED ALARM
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
g004915
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
3. Take each MIC to be installed in the replacement MPC out of its electrostatic bag,
and identify the slot on the MPC where it will be connected.
4. Verify that each fiber-optic MIC has a rubber safety cap covering the MIC transceiver.
If it does not, cover the transceiver with a safety cap.
6. Locate the slot in the card cage in which you plan to install the MPC.
8. Lift the MPC into place, and carefully align the sides of the MPC with the guides inside
the card cage.
CAUTION: When the MPC is out of the chassis, do not hold it by the ejector
handles, bus bars, or edge connectors. They cannot support its weight.
9. Slide the MPC all the way into the card cage until you feel resistance.
10. Grasp both ejector handles, and rotate them clockwise simultaneously until the MPC
is fully seated.
11. If any of the MICs on the MPC connect to fiber-optic cable, remove the rubber safety
cap from each transceiver and cable.
12. Insert the appropriate cable into the cable connector ports on each MIC on the MPC.
Secure the cables so that they are not supporting their own weight. Place excess cable
out of the way in a neatly coiled loop, using the cable management system. Placing
fasteners on a loop helps to maintain its shape.
CAUTION: Do not let fiber-optic cables hang free from the connector. Do
not allow the fastened loops of a cable to dangle, which stresses the cable
at the fastening point.
13. Use one of the following methods to bring the MPC online:
• Press and hold the corresponding MPC online button on the craft interface until the
green OK/FAIL LED next to the button lights steadily, in about 5 seconds.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
CAUTION: After the OK/FAIL LED lights steadily, wait at least 30 seconds
before removing the MPC again, removing an MPC from a different slot,
or inserting an MPC in a different slot.
You can also verify correct MPC and MIC functioning by issuing the show chassis fpc and
show chassis fpc pic-status commands described in “Maintaining MX960 MPCs” on
page 461 and “Maintaining MX960 MICs” on page 460.
0
MASTER
1 YELLOW ALARM
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE RED ALARM
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
g004911
The PICs are located in the FPCs installed in the front of the router. A PIC weighs less
than 2 lb (0.9 kg).
1. Place an electrostatic bag or antistatic mat on a flat, stable surface to receive the
PIC. If the PIC connects to fiber-optic cable, have ready a rubber safety cap for each
transceiver and cable.
2. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
• Press its online/offline button. For a PIC installed in FPC3, use a narrow-ended tool
that fits inside the opening that leads to the button. Press and hold the button until
the PIC LED goes out (about 5 seconds).
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
4. Label the cables connected to the PIC so that you can later reconnect each cable to
the correct PIC.
5. Disconnect the cables from the PIC. If the PIC uses fiber-optic cable, immediately
cover each transceiver and the end of each cable with a rubber safety cap.
6. Arrange the cable in the standard or extended cable manager to prevent it from
dislodging or developing stress points. Secure the cable so that it is not supporting its
own weight as it hangs to the floor. Place excess cable out of the way in a neatly coiled
loop. Placing fasteners on the loop helps to maintain its shape.
7. For an FPC3 PIC, loosen the captive screw at the bottom of the PIC faceplate, then
twist the ejector handle at the top of the faceplate counterclockwise to unseat the
PIC.
8. Slide the PIC out of the FPC card carrier and place it in the electrostatic bag or on the
antistatic mat.
9. If you are not reinstalling a PIC into the emptied PIC slot within a short time, install a
blank PIC panel over the slot to maintain proper airflow in the FPC card cage.
g004412
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. If the PIC uses fiber-optic cable, verify that a rubber safety cap is over each transceiver
on the faceplate. Install a cap if necessary.
3. Align the notches in the connector at the rear of the PIC with the notches in the PIC
slot in the FPC and then slide the PIC in until it lodges firmly in the FPC.
CAUTION: Slide the PIC straight into the slot to avoid damaging the
components on the bottom of the PIC.
4. For an FPC3 PIC, turn the ejector handle at the top of the PIC faceplate clockwise,
then tighten the captive screw at the bottom of the faceplate to secure the PIC in the
FPC.
5. If the PIC uses fiber-optic cable, remove the rubber safety cap from each transceiver
and the end of each cable.
6. Insert the appropriate cables into the cable connectors on the PIC.
7. Arrange the cable in the standard or extended cable manager to prevent it from
dislodging or developing stress points. Secure the cable so that it is not supporting its
own weight as it hangs to the floor. Place excess cable out of the way in a neatly coiled
loop. Placing fasteners on the loop helps to maintain its shape.
CAUTION: Do not let fiber-optic cables hang free from the connector. Do
not allow the fastened loops of a cable to dangle, which stresses the cable
at the fastening point.
• Press the PIC offline/online button until the PIC LED lights green. For a PIC installed
in FPC3, use a narrow-ended tool that fits inside the opening that leads to the button.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
The normal functioning status LED confirms that the PIC is online. You can also verify
correct PIC functioning by issuing the show chassis fpc pic-status command described
in “Maintaining MX960 PICs” on page 464.
1. If the component connects to fiber-optic cable, have ready a rubber safety cap for
each cable and transceiver.
2. If removing all cables connected to the component, use one of the following methods
to take the component offline:
• Press and hold the corresponding online button on the craft interface. The green
OK LED next to the button begins to blink. Hold the button down until the LED
goes off.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
• Press the online/offline button on the PIC. For a PIC installed in an FPC3, use a
narrow-ended tool that fits inside the opening that leads to the button. Press and
hold the button until the PIC LED goes out (about 5 seconds).
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
• Press the online/offline button on the MIC. Use a narrow-ended tool that fits
inside the opening that leads to the button. Press and hold the button until the
MIC LED goes off (about 5 seconds).
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
3. Unplug the cable from the cable connector port. If the PIC uses fiber-optic cable,
immediately cover each transceiver and the end of each cable with a rubber safety
cap.
4. Remove the cable from the cable manager and detach it from the destination port.
• Replacing an SFP or XFP Transceiver on an MX960 DPC, MPC, MIC, or PIC on page 388
1. Have ready a length of the type of cable used by the component. For cable
specifications, see the MX Series Interface Module Reference.
2. If the cable connector port is covered by a rubber safety cap, remove the cap.
3. Insert the cable connector into the cable connector port on the component faceplate.
4. Arrange the cable in the standard or extended cable manager to prevent it from
dislodging or developing stress points. Secure the cable so that it is not supporting its
own weight as it hangs to the floor. Place excess cable out of the way in a neatly coiled
loop. Placing fasteners on the loop helps to maintain its shape.
CAUTION: Do not let fiber-optic cables hang free from the connector. Do
not allow the fastened loops of a cable to dangle, which stresses the cable
at the fastening point.
5. Insert the other end of the cable into the destination port.
7. If the component is offline (its failure indicator LED is lit), use one of the following
methods to bring it online.
• Press and hold the corresponding online button on the craft interface until the
green OK LED next to the button lights steadily, in about 5 seconds.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
• Press the PIC offline/online button until the PIC LED lights green. For a PIC installed
in FPC3, use a narrow-ended tool that fits inside the opening that leads to the
button.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
• Press the MIC offline/online button until the MIC LED lights green.
For more information about the command, see the CLI Explorer.
The normal functioning indicator LED confirms that the component is online. You can
also verify correct DPC or MPC functioning by issuing the show chassis fpc command
or the correct PIC or MIC functioning by issuing the show chassis fpc pic-status
command.
• Maintaining Cables That Connect to MX960 DPCs, MPCs, MICs, or PICs on page 465
• Replacing an SFP or XFP Transceiver on an MX960 DPC, MPC, MIC, or PIC on page 388
Small form-factor pluggable (SFPs) and XFPs are optical transceivers that are installed
in a DPC or PIC. SFPs and XFPs are hot-insertable and hot-removable.
1. Removing an SFP or XFP Transceiver from an MX960 DPC, MPC, MIC, or PIC on page 388
2. Installing an SFP or XFP Transceiver into an MX960 DPC, MPC, MIC, or PIC on page 389
Removing an SFP or XFP Transceiver from an MX960 DPC, MPC, MIC, or PIC
Removing an SFP or XFP does not interrupt DPC, MPC, MIC, or PIC functioning, but the
removed SFP or XFP no longer receives or transmits data.
2. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
3. Label the cables connected to the transceiver so that you can reconnect them correctly
later.
5. Pull the ejector handle out from the transceiver to unlock the transceiver.
CAUTION: Make sure that you open the ejector handle completely until
you hear it click. This prevents damage to the transceiver.
Use needlenose pliers to pull the ejector handle out from the transceiver.
6. Grasp the transceiver ejector handle, and pull the transceiver approximately 0.5 in. (1.3
cm) out of the DPC, MPC, MIC, or PIC.
7. Using your fingers, grasp the body of the transceiver, and pull it the rest of the way
out of the DPC, MPC, MIC, or PIC.
• Installing an SFP or XFP Transceiver into an MX960 DPC, MPC, MIC, or PIC on page 296
Installing an SFP or XFP Transceiver into an MX960 DPC, MPC, MIC, or PIC
To install an SFP or XFP:
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Take each transceiver to be installed out of its electrostatic bag, and identify the slot
on the component where it will be installed.
3. Verify that each transceiver is covered by a rubber safety cap. If it is not, cover the
transceiver with a safety cap.
4. Carefully align the transceiver with the slots in the component. The connectors should
face the component.
5. Slide the transceiver until the connector is seated in the component slot. If you are
unable to fully insert the transceiver, make sure the connector is facing the right way.
7. Remove the rubber safety cap from the transceiver and the end of the cable. Insert
the cable into the transceiver.
8. Verify that the status LEDs on the component faceplate indicate that the SFP or XFP
is functioning correctly. For more information about the component LEDs, see the MX
Series Interface Module Reference.
• Removing an SFP or XFP Transceiver from an MX960 DPC, MPC, MIC, or PIC on page 388
1. Place an electrostatic bag or antistatic mat on a flat, stable surface to receive the
CFP transceiver. Have ready a rubber safety cap for the CFP2 transceiver and the
cable.
2. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist, and connect
the strap to one of the ESD points on the chassis.
3. Label the cable connected to the CFP2 transceiver so that you can later reconnect it
to the correct CFP2 transceiver.
4. Disconnect the cable from the CFP2 transceiver. Immediately cover the transceiver
and the end of the cable with a rubber safety cap.
5. Arrange the cable in the cable management system to prevent it from dislodging or
developing stress points. Secure the cable so that it is not supporting its own weight
as it hangs to the floor. Place excess cable out of the way in a neatly coiled loop in
the cable management system. Placing fasteners on the loop helps to maintain its
shape.
6. Pull the ejector latch to the extreme end away from the CFP2 transceiver faceplate
to unseat the CFP2 transceiver from the PIC. Pull the CFP2 transceiver out of the PIC
and place it on the antistatic mat or in the electrostatic bag.
NOTE: You cannot remove the transceiver until you move the ejector latch
to the extreme end.
1. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist, and connect
the strap to one of the ESD points on the chassis.
2. Verify that a rubber safety cap covers the CFP transceiver, installing one if necessary.
3. Orient the CFP2 over the port in the PIC so that the connector end will enter the slot
first and the CFP2 connector faces the appropriate direction.
4. Slide the CFP2 into the slot. If there is resistance, remove the CFP2 and flip it so that
the connector faces the other direction.
5. Remove the rubber safety cap from the transceiver and the end of the cable, and
insert the cable into the transceiver.
6. Arrange the cable in the cable management system to prevent the cable from
dislodging or developing stress points. Secure the cable so that it is not supporting its
own weight as it hangs to the floor. Place excess cable out of the way in a neatly coiled
loop in the cable management system. Placing fasteners on the loop helps to maintain
its shape.
CAUTION: Do not let fiber-optic cable hang free from the connector. Do
not allow fastened loops of cable to dangle, which stresses the cable at
the fastening point.
7. Verify that the status LEDs on the PIC faceplate indicate that the CFP2 is functioning
correctly. You can also verify PIC functioning by issuing the show chassis fpc pic-status
command.
You can use the Hardware Compatibility Tool to find information about the pluggable
transceivers supported on your Juniper Networks device.
1. Place an electrostatic bag or antistatic mat on a flat, stable surface to receive the
CFP transceiver. Have ready a rubber safety cap for the CFP transceiver and the cable.
2. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist, and connect
the strap to the ESD point on the chassis.
3. Label the cable connected to the CFP transceiver so that you can later reconnect it
to the correct CFP transceiver.
4. Disconnect the cable from the CFP transceiver. Immediately cover the transceiver
and the end of the cable with a rubber safety cap.
5. Arrange the cable in the cable management system to prevent it from dislodging or
developing stress points. Secure the cable so that it is not supporting its own weight
as it hangs to the floor.
6. Unscrew the screws from the CFP transceiver faceplate to unseat the CFP transceiver
from the line card. Pull the CFP transceiver out of the line card and place it on the
antistatic mat or in the electrostatic bag.
1. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist, and connect
the strap to the ESD point on the chassis.
2. Verify that a rubber safety cap covers the CFP transceiver, installing one if necessary.
3. Orient the CFP over the port in the line card so that the connector end will enter the
slot first and the CFP connector faces the appropriate direction.
4. Slide the CFP into the slot. If there is resistance, remove the CFP and flip it so that the
connector faces the other direction.
5. Remove the rubber safety cap from the transceiver and the end of the cable, and
insert the cable into the transceiver.
6. Arrange the cable in the cable management system to prevent the cable from
dislodging or developing stress points. Secure the cable so that it is not supporting its
own weight as it hangs to the floor.
CAUTION: Do not let fiber-optic cable hang free from the connector. Do
not allow fastened loops of cable to dangle, which stresses the cable at
the fastening point.
7. Verify that any status LEDs on the line card faceplate indicate that the CFP is
functioning correctly. For more information about the line card LEDs, see the MX Series
5G Universal Routing Platform Interface Module Reference. You can also verify line card
functioning by issuing the show chassis fpc pic-status command.
NOTE: The minimum number of power supplies must be present in the router
at all times.
NOTE: After powering off a power supply, wait at least 60 seconds before
turning it back on.
1. Switch off the dedicated customer site circuit breaker for the power supply, and
remove the power cord from the AC power source. Follow the ESD and disconnection
instructions for your site.
2. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
3. Move the AC input switch in the chassis above the power supply to the off (O) position.
4. While grasping the handle on the power supply faceplate with one hand, use your
other hand to pull the spring-loaded locking pin in the release lever away from the
chassis and turn the release lever counterclockwise until it stops.
5. Let go of the locking pin in the release lever. Ensure that the pin is seated inside the
corresponding hole in the chassis.
WARNING: Do not touch the power connector on the top of the power
supply (see Figure 162 on page 399). It can contain dangerous voltages.
1. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
2. Move the AC input switch in the chassis above the empty power supply slot to the off
(O) position.
3. Ensure that the release lever below the empty power supply slot is locked in the
counterclockwise position (see Figure 102 on page 286).
If necessary, pull the spring-loaded locking pin in the release lever away from the
chassis and turn the release lever counterclockwise until it stops. Let go of the locking
pin in the release lever. Ensure that the pin is seated inside the corresponding hole in
the chassis.
4. Using both hands, slide the power supply straight into the chassis until the power
supply is fully seated in the chassis slot. The power supply faceplate should be flush
with any adjacent power supply faceplates.
The small tab on the metal housing that is controlled by the release lever must be
inside of the corresponding slot at the bottom of the power supply (see
Figure 102 on page 286). This tab is used to pull the power supply down in the chassis
slot, prior to removing the power supply.
5. While firmly pushing the handle on the power supply faceplate with one hand, use
your other hand to pull the spring-loaded locking pin in the release lever away from
the chassis and turn the release lever clockwise until it stops.
6. Let go of the locking pin in the release lever. Ensure that the pin is seated inside the
corresponding hole in the chassis.
7. Move the AC input switch in the chassis above the power supply to the on (—) position
and observe the status LEDs on the power supply faceplate. If the power supply is
correctly installed and functioning normally, the AC OK and DC OK LEDs light steadily,
and the PS FAIL LED is not lit.
NOTE: The minimum number of power supplies must be present in the router
at all times.
NOTE: After powering off a power supply, wait at least 60 seconds before
turning it back on.
1. Switch off the dedicated customer site circuit breaker for the power supply being
removed. Follow your site's procedures for ESD.
2. Make sure that the voltage across the DC power source cable leads is 0 V and that
there is no chance that the cables might become active during the removal process.
3. Verify that the INPUT OK LEDs on the power supply to be removed are not lit.
4. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
5. Move the DC circuit breaker on the power supply faceplate to the off (O) position.
6. Remove the clear plastic cover protecting the terminal studs on the faceplate.
7. Remove the nut and washer from each of the terminal studs. (Use a 7/16-in.
[11 mm] nut driver or socket wrench.)
9. Loosen the captive screw on the cable restraint on the lower edge of the power supply
faceplate.
11. While grasping the handle on the power supply faceplate with one hand, use your
other hand to pull the spring-loaded locking pin in the release lever away from the
chassis and turn the release lever counterclockwise until it stops.
12. Let go of the locking pin in the release lever. Ensure that the pin is seated inside the
corresponding hole in the chassis.
WARNING: Do not touch the power connector on the top of the power
supply (see Figure 165 on page 404). It can contain dangerous voltages.
1. Ensure that the voltage across the DC power source cable leads is 0 V and that there
is no chance that the cable leads might become active during installation.
2. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
3. Move the DC circuit breaker on the power supply faceplate to the off (O) position.
4. Ensure that the release lever below the empty power supply slot is locked in the
counterclockwise position (see Figure 103 on page 290).
If necessary, pull the spring-loaded locking pin in the release lever away from the
chassis and turn the release lever counterclockwise until it stops. Let go of the locking
pin in the release lever. Ensure that the pin is seated inside the corresponding hole in
the chassis.
5. Using both hands, slide the power supply straight into the chassis until the power
supply is fully seated in the chassis slot. The power supply faceplate should be flush
with any adjacent power supply faceplates.
The small tab on the metal housing that is controlled by the release lever must be
inside of the corresponding slot at the bottom of the power supply (see
Figure 103 on page 290). This tab is used to pull the power supply down in the chassis
slot, prior to removing the power supply.
6. While firmly pushing the handle on the power supply faceplate with one hand, use
your other hand to pull the spring-loaded locking pin in the release lever away from
the chassis and turn the release lever clockwise until it stops.
7. Let go of the locking pin in the release lever. Ensure that the pin is seated inside the
corresponding hole in the chassis.
8. Remove the clear plastic cover protecting the terminal studs on the faceplate.
9. Remove the nut and washer from each of the terminal studs.
10. Secure each power cable lug to the terminal studs, first with the split washer, then
with the nut. Apply between 23 lb-in. (2.6 Nm) and 25 lb-in. (2.8 Nm) of torque to
each nut (see Figure 104 on page 291). Do not overtighten the nut. (Use a
7/16-in. (11 mm) torque-controlled driver or socket wrench.)
a. Attach the positive (+) DC source power cable lug to the RTN (return) terminal.
b. Attach the negative (–) DC source power cable lug to the –48V (input) terminal.
CAUTION: Ensure that each power cable lug seats flush against the surface
of the terminal block as you are tightening the nuts. Ensure that each nut
is properly threaded onto the terminal stud. The nut should be able to spin
freely with your fingers when it is first placed onto the terminal stud.
Applying installation torque to the nut when improperly threaded may
result in damage to the terminal stud.
CAUTION: You must ensure that power connections maintain the proper
polarity. The power source cables might be labeled (+) and (–) to indicate
their polarity. There is no standard color coding for DC power cables. The
color coding used by the external DC power source at your site determines
the color coding for the leads on the power cables that attach to the
terminal studs on each power supply.
NOTE: The DC power supplies in slots PEM0 and PEM1 must be powered
by dedicated power feeds derived from feed A, and the DC power supplies
in PEM2 and PEM3 must be powered by dedicated power feeds derived
from feed B. This configuration provides the commonly deployed A/B feed
redundancy for the system. For information about connecting to DC power
sources, see “Electrical Specifications for the MX960 DC Power Supply”
on page 159.
11. Loosen the captive screw on the cable restraint on the lower edge of the power supply
faceplate.
12. Route the positive and negative DC power cables through the left and right sides of
the cable restraint.
13. Tighten the cable restraint captive screw to hold the power cables in place.
14. Replace the clear plastic cover over the terminal studs on the faceplate.
15. Verify that the power cabling is correct, that the cables are not touching, and that they
do not block access to router components or drape where people could trip on them.
17. Verify that the INPUT OK LED on the power supply is lit steadily.
18. On each of the DC power supplies, switch the DC circuit breaker to the center position
before moving it to the on (|) position.
NOTE: The circuit breaker may bounce back to the off (O) position if you
move the breaker too quickly.
1. Move the AC input switch, which is to the right of the appliance inlet on the chassis,
to the off (O) position.
3. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
4. Unplug the power cord from the appliance inlet on the power supply.
1. Locate a replacement power cord with the type of plug appropriate for your
geographical location (see “AC Power Cord Specifications for the MX960 Router” on
page 156).
2. Plug the replacement power cord into the corresponding appliance inlet located in
the chassis directly above the power supply.
3. Insert the power cord plug into an external AC power source receptacle.
4. Dress the power cord appropriately. Verify that the power cord does not block the air
exhaust and access to router components, or drape where people could trip on it.
5. Move the AC input switch in the chassis above the power supply to the on (—)position
and observe the status LEDs on the power supply faceplate. If the power supply is
correctly installed and functioning normally, the AC OK and DC OK LEDs light steadily,
and the PS FAIL LED is not lit.
1. Switch off the dedicated customer site circuit breaker for the power supply being
removed. Follow your site's procedures for ESD.
2. Make sure that the voltage across the DC power source cable leads is 0 V and that
there is no chance that the cables might become active during the removal process.
3. Verify that the INPUT OK LED on the power supply is not lit.
5. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
6. Move the DC circuit breaker on the power supply faceplate to the off (O) position.
7. Remove the clear plastic cover protecting the terminal studs on the faceplate.
8. Remove the nut and washer from each of the terminal studs. (Use a 7/16-in.
[11 mm] nut driver or socket wrench.)
10. Loosen the captive screw on the cable restraint on the lower edge of the power supply
faceplate.
1. Locate a replacement power cable that meets the specifications defined in “Electrical
Specifications for the MX960 DC Power Supply” on page 159.
2. Verify that a licensed electrician has attached a cable lug to the replacement power
cable.
4. Secure the power cable lug to the terminal studs, first with the split washer, then with
the nut. Apply between 23 lb-in. (2.6 Nm) and 25 lb-in. (2.8 Nm) of torque to each
nut (see Figure 73 on page 235). Do not overtighten the nut. (Use a 7/16-in. (11 mm)
torque-controlled driver or socket wrench.)
CAUTION: Ensure that each power cable lug seats flush against the surface
of the terminal block as you are tightening the nuts. Ensure that each nut
is properly threaded onto the terminal stud. The nut should be able to spin
freely with your fingers when it is first placed onto the terminal stud.
Applying installation torque to the nut when improperly threaded may
result in damage to the terminal stud.
Terminal
studs
Cable
lug
Split
washer
Nut
g017594
5. Route the power cable through the cable restraint. Make sure that the cable does not
touch or obstruct any router components.
6. Tighten the cable restraint captive screw to hold the power cables in place.
7. Verify that the DC power cable is connected correctly, that it does not touch or block
access to router components, and that it does not drape where people could trip on
it.
8. Replace the clear plastic cover over the terminal studs on the faceplate.
10. Turn on the dedicated customer site circuit breaker to the power supply.
11. Verify that the INPUT OK LED on the power supply is lit steadily.
12. On each of the DC power supplies, switch the DC circuit breaker to the center position
before moving it to the on (|) position.
NOTE: The circuit breaker may bounce back to the off (O) position if you
move the breaker too quickly.
Observe the status LEDs on the power supply faceplate. If the power supply is correctly
installed and functioning normally, the PWR OK, BRKR ON, and INPUT OK LEDs light
green steadily.
See Also • DC Power Cable Specifications for the MX960 Router on page 175
Before replacing an SCB, read the guidelines in Operating and Positioning the MX960 SCB
Ejectors.
NOTE: You can remove the SCB and Routing Engine as a unit, or remove the
Routing Engine separately.
CAUTION: Before removing an SCB, ensure that you know how to operate
the ejector handles properly to avoid damage to the equipment.
NOTE: You do not need to offline the host subsystem in the following
scenarios:
• You are replacing an SCB that functions as a third SCB and no Routing
Engine is installed.
NOTE: If there is only one host subsystem, taking the host subsystem
offline shuts down the router and you are not required to offline the SCB.
4. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
6. Grasp the ejector handles, and slide the SCB about halfway out of the chassis.
7. Place one hand underneath the SCB to support it, and slide it completely out of the
chassis.
9. If you are not replacing the SCB now, install a blank panel over the empty slot.
0
MASTER
1 YELL
OW ALAR
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE M RED ALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
1 0 1 0 1 0 1
0
g004048
2. Carefully align the sides of the Switch Control Board with the guides inside the chassis.
3. Slide the Switch Control Board into the chassis until you feel resistance, carefully
ensuring that it is correctly aligned.
4. Grasp both ejector handles, and rotate them simultaneously clockwise until the Switch
Control Board is fully seated.
5. Place the ejector handles in the proper position, horizontally and toward the center
of the board.
6. Check the LEDs on the Switch Control Board faceplate to verify that it is functioning
normally.
• The green OK/FAIL LED should light steadily a few minutes after the Switch Control
Board is installed.
• If the OK/FAIL LED is red, remove and install the Switch Control Board again. If the
OK/FAIL LED still lights steadily, the Switch Control Board is not functioning properly.
Contact your customer support representative.
7. Check the status of the Switch Control Board using the show chassis environment cb
command:
CB 0 status:
State Online Master
Temperature 25 degrees C / 77 degrees F
Power 1
1.2 V 1198 mV
1.5 V 1508 mV
1.8 V 1830 mV
2.5 V 5059 mV
3.3 V 6593 mV
5.0 V 5111 mV
12.0 V 12181 mV
1.25 V 1250 mV
3.3 V SM3 6587 mV
5 V RE 5078 mV
12 V RE 12026 mV
Power 2
This topic describes how to upgrade your MX960, MX480, or MX240 router to use the
SCBE-MX without taking the router offline. This “in-service” upgrade only works for MX
routers with DPC, MS-DPC, MPC1, MPC2, or MPC3 line cards. If your MX router has another
type of line card, you’ll need to take the router offline before you do the upgrade.
Before you do the upgrade, open a telnet session to the master Routing Engine CLI
operational mode and issue the configure exclusive command. This command locks the
configuration to prevent accidental changes during the upgrade process. .lock the current
configuration there are no changes to the CLI during the upgrade process.
TIP: To prevent traffic loss during the upgrade process, we recommend that
you operate the line cards at 50% line rate. This 50% limit must be
maintained per PFE on each line card.
3. Upgrade the SCB-MX in the Backup Routing Engine Slot 1 (SCB 1) on page 422
4. Upgrade the SCB-MX in the Master Routing Engine Slot 0 (SCB 0) on page 424
1. Verify that the system runs Junos OS Release 11.4 or later by issuing the show version
command on the master router. Here’s an example for the MX960:
Model: mx960
Junos Base OS Software Suite [11.4-20110530];
The latest software ensures a healthy system—that is, Routing Engines, control boards,
and FPCs—before the upgrade.
SCB-MX details are displayed as above, along with other hardware components.
3. Establish console connections to both Routing Engines. You can use a telnet session
to connect to the router console by issuing the <router name>-con command. For
example, if the router name is juniper, you can connect to RE0 and RE1 consoles by
issuing the telnet juniper-con and telnet juniper1-con commands.
4. Ensure that graceful switchover (GRES), commit synchronize (required for nonstop
routing), and nonstop routing (NSR) are enabled or configured by running the set
chassis redundancy graceful-switchover, set system commit synchronize, set
routing-options nonstop-routing commands.
NOTE: These commands are mandatory for this upgrade and may be
removed, if desired, after the upgrade.
5. Set the upgrade flag on and start the SCB-MX upgrade by issuing the set chassis state
cb-upgrade on command.
user@host# configure
user@host# set chassis state cb-upgrade on
user@host# commit
6. Determine the order to replace the existing SCB-MXs with upgraded ones. SCB 0, SCB
1, and SCB 2 are available for the MX960. SCB 0 is associated with RE0, SCB 1 is
associated with RE1, and SCB 2 is the spare SCB. The SCB upgrade order for the
MX960 is:
NOTE: Do not add or remove any router hardware during the upgrade
procedure.
2. Verify that fabric plane 4 is offline by issuing the show chassis fabric summary
command.
3. Take the next fabric plane offline by issuing the request chassis fabric plane 5 offline
command, and then verify that the fabric plane is offline by issuing the command
given in Step 2.
4. Take the SCB-MX in slot 2 offline by issuing the request chassis cb offline slot 2
command.
5. Verify that the control board is offline by issuing the show chassis environment cb 2
command:
CB 2 status:
State Offline
Power 1 Disabled
Power 2 Disabled
6. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist, and connect
the strap to one of the ESD points on the chassis.
7. Remove and replace the SCB-MX in slot 2 on the router (SCB 2) with the SCBE. Use
the procedure described in “Replacing an MX960 SCB” on page 415.
CB 2 status
State Online
Temperature 30 degrees C / 86 degrees F
9. Verify that the fabric planes come online correctly by issuing the show chassis fabric
summary command:
Because only one SCB-MX has been upgraded, the alarm indicates that the SCBs are
of mixed type. This alarm is cleared after all the control boards are upgraded.
2. Ensure that the Routing Engine is powered down by issuing the show chassis
routing-engine 1 command. The slot of the Routing Engine may be 0 or 1, and is shown
as 1 in this example:
Verify that the Current State is Present, which indicates that the Routing Engine is
offline.
3. Take the first fabric plane of the backup Routing Engine offline by issuing the request
chassis fabric plane 3 offline command.
4. Verify that the fabric plane is offline by issuing the show chassis fabric summary
command.
5. Take the next fabric plane offline by issuing the request chassis fabric plane 2 offline
command and verify that the fabric plane is offline by issuing the command in Step
4.
6. Take the SCB-MX in slot 1 offline by issuing the request chassis cb offline slot 1
command.
7. Verify that the SCB-MX is offline by issuing the show chassis environment cb 1
command:
CB 1 status:
State Offline
Power 1 Disabled
Power 2 Disabled
8. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist, and connect
the strap to one of the ESD points on the chassis.
9. Remove and replace the offline SCB-MX on the router with the SCBE.
10. Verify that the installation is successful and the SCB is online by issuing the show
chassis environment cb 1 command:
CB 1 status
State Online
Temperature 30 degrees C / 86 degrees F
Other details, such as power, are also displayed along with the state.
11. Verify that the fabric planes 2 and 3 come online correctly by issuing the show chassis
fabric summary command:
12. Verify that the backup routing engine is back online by issuing the show chassis
routing-engine 1 command:
3. Switch the configuration mode to ensure that you are still in configure exclusive mode
by issuing the exit command and then the configure exclusive command, from the old
master Routing Engine.
4. Log in to the current master Routing Engine again and issue the configure exclusive
command.
5. Power down the backup Routing Engine from the master Routing Engine by issuing
the request system power-off other-routing-engine command.
6. Ensure that the Routing Engine is powered down by issuing the show chassis
routing-engine 0 command. The slot of the Routing Engine may be 0 or 1, and is shown
as 1 in this example:
Verify that the Current State is Present, which indicates that the Routing Engine is
offline or powered down.
7. Take the first fabric plane of the backup Routing Engine offline by issuing the request
chassis fabric plane offline 1 command.
8. Verify that the fabric plane is offline by issuing the show chassis fabric summary
command.
9. Take the next fabric plane offline by issuing the request chassis fabric plane offline 0
command and verify that the fabric plane is offline by issuing the command given in
Step 2.
10. Take the SCB-MX in slot 0 offline by issuing the request chassis cb offline slot 0
command.
11. Verify that the control board is offline by issuing the show chassis environment cb 0
command:
CB 0 status:
State Offline
Power 1 Disabled
Power 2 Disabled
12. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist, and connect
the strap to one of the ESD points on the chassis.
13. Remove and replace the offline SCB-MX on the router with the SCBE. Use the
procedure described in “Replacing an MX960 SCB” on page 415.
14. Verify that the installation is successful and the SCBE is online by issuing the show
chassis environment cb 0 command:
CB 0 status
State Online
Temperature 30 degrees C / 86 degrees F
15. Verify that the fabric planes 0 and 1 come online correctly by issuing the show chassis
fabric summary command:
16. Verify that the backup Routing Engine is back online by issuing the show chassis
routing-engine 0 command:
17. Verify the alarms by issuing the show chassis alarms command:
The major alarm has changed from CB fabrics are of mixed types to CB fabric links
require upgrade/training, as a SCB-MX requires training to change the link speed from
3G to 6G for the SCBE-MX. This alarm is displayed until the 3G to 6G link transition is
completed.
Slot State
0 Upgrade not supported
1 Upgraded
2 Empty
3 Empty
4 Empty
5 Empty
6 Empty
7 Empty
In this example, the results indicate that slot 0 does not support the upgrade and slot
1 needs upgrade.
NOTE: The SCBE line card supports only DPC, MS-DPC, MPC1, MPC2, and
MPC3 line cards for the upgrade-bandwidth. If line cards that do not support
the command option are present in the chassis during the SCB-MX to
SCBE-MX upgrade, the request chassis fabric upgrade-bandwidth
commands will return Upgrade not supported for the slot(s) that contain
the unsupported line card(s).
2. Upgrade the bandwidth of all MPCs by issuing the request chassis fabric
upgrade-bandwidth fpc all command. If you want to control the MPC line card upgrade,
go to Step 3.
CAUTION: Use this command only if you are not concerned with the slot
upgrade order or if only one old MPC is present in the chassis. Running this
command may result in a loss of traffic across that MPC. Using this method
may increase that loss, as it does not consider any redundancy or graceful
switchover strategies that you may have configured on the system.
3. Issue the request chassis fabric upgrade-bandwidth fpc slot 1 command to upgrade
the MPC in slot 1.
Slot State
0 Upgrade not supported
1 Upgraded
2 Empty
FPC 1
PFE #0
Plane 0: Links ok
Plane 1: Links ok
Plane 2: Plane enabled
Plane 3: Plane enabled
Plane 4: Plane enabled
Plane 5: Plane enabled
PFE #1
Plane 0: Links ok
Plane 1: Links ok
Plane 2: Plane enabled
Plane 3: Plane enabled
Plane 4: Plane enabled
Plane 5: Plane enabled
PFE #2
Plane 0: Links ok
Plane 1: Links ok
Plane 2: Plane enabled
Plane 3: Plane enabled
Plane 4: Plane enabled
Plane 5: Plane enabled
PFE #3
Plane 0: Links ok
Plane 1: Links ok
Plane 2: Plane enabled
Plane 3: Plane enabled
Plane 4: Plane enabled
Plane 5: Plane enabled
7. Verify if the show chassis fabric summary command output shows fabric planes in the
'check' state. This indicates that the fabric plane has an error. You can try to recover
the fabric plane to normal operation by issuing the request chassis fabric plane <#>
offline command, followed by the request chassis fabric plane <#> online command,
where <#> equals the fabric plane in error.
NOTE: After you issue the request chassis fabric plane <#> offline and
request chassis fabric plane <#> online commands, issue the show chassis
fabric summary command to verify that the fabric plane errors are rectified
and to verify the current state of the fabric planes.
In this example, the major alarms are no longer displayed, and the upgrade is
successfully completed.
9. Disable the upgrade configuration by issuing the set chassis state cb-upgrade off
command and then the commit command.
10. Disable the upgrade configuration by issuing the set chassis state cb-upgrade off
command.
11. You can delete the upgrade configuration by issuing the delete chassis state cb-upgrade
command and then the commit command.
12. Verify the SCBE-MXs are installed by issuing the show chassis hardware command:
Scenario 1: SCBE2-MX; Routing Engine with Junos OS Release 13.3R1 or later installed.
• Replace the SCBs. Ensure you replace the Routing Engines at the same time.
Scenario 2: SCB-MX or SCBE-MX; existing Routing Engine with a Junos OS Release 13.3R1
or earlier installed.
• Upgrade the Routing Engine (RE0 and RE1) software to Junos OS Release 13.3 or later.
• Replace the SCBs. Ensure that you replace the SCBs at the same time.
Scenario 3: Failed SCB-MX or SCBE-MX; Routing Engine with a Junos OS Release 13.3R1
or earlier installed.
• Upgrade the software on the Routing Engine hosting the failed SCB-MX or SCBE-MX
with Junos OS Release 13.3R1 or later.
• Replace the SCBs. Ensure that you replace the SCBs at the same time.
• Upgrade the software on the Routing Engine hosting the SCBE2-MX with Junos OS
Release 13.3R1 or later.
NOTE: You cannot upgrade to SCBE2-MX without powering off the MX960
router.
4. Install the MX960 Routing Engine into the SCBE2-MX on page 432
Model: mx960
Junos Base OS Software Suite [13.3-yyyymmdd];
...
The latest software ensures a healthy system—that is, a system that comprises Routing
Engines, control boards, and FPCs—before the upgrade.
For information about how to verify and upgrade the Junos OS, see the Junos OS
Installation and Upgrade Guide.
NOTE: After turning off the power supply, wait at least 60 seconds before
turning it back on.
1. On the external management device connected to the Routing Engine, issue the
request system halt both-routing-engines operational mode command. The command
shuts down the Routing Engines cleanly, so that their state information is preserved.
(If the router contains only one Routing Engine, issue the request system halt
command.)
2. Wait until a message appears on the console confirming that the operating system
has halted.
3. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect
the strap to one of the ESD points on the chassis.
4. Move the AC input switch on the chassis above the AC power supply or the DC circuit
breaker on each DC power supply faceplate to the off (O) position.
3. Attach an electrostatic discharge (ESD) grounding strap to your bare wrist, and connect
the strap to one of the ESD points on the chassis.
4. Loosen the captive screws on the top and bottom of the Routing Engine.
6. Grasp the Routing Engine by the ejector handles, and slide it about halfway out of the
chassis.
7. Place one hand underneath the Routing Engine to support it, and slide it completely
out of the chassis.
2. Ensure that the ejector handles are not in the locked position. If necessary, flip the
ejector handles outward.
4. Carefully align the sides of the Routing Engine with the guides inside the opening on
the SCBE2-MX.
5. Slide the Routing Engine into the SCBE2-MX until you feel resistance and then press
the faceplate of the Routing Engine until it engages the connectors.
6. Press both of the ejector handles inward to seat the Routing Engine.
7. Tighten the captive screws on the top and bottom of the Routing Engine.
2. Verify that each AC power cord is securely inserted into its appliance inlet.
3. Verify that an external management device is connected to one of the Routing Engine
ports (AUX, CONSOLE, or ETHERNET).
5. Switch on the dedicated customer-site circuit breakers. Follow the ESD and safety
instructions for your site.
6. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
7. Move the AC input switch on the chassis above the AC power supply or the DC circuit
breaker on each DC power-supply faceplate to the off (—) position.
8. Check that the AC or the DC power supply is correctly installed and functioning
normally. Verify that the AC OK and DC OK LEDs light steadily, and the PS FAIL LED is
not lit.
If any of the status LEDs indicates that the power supply is not functioning normally,
repeat the installation and cabling procedures.
9. On the external management device connected to the Routing Engine, monitor the
startup process to verify that the system has booted properly.
NOTE: If the system is completely powered off when you power on the
power supply, the Routing Engine boots as the power supply completes
its startup sequence. Normally, the router boots from the Junos OS on the
CompactFlash card.
CB 0 status
State Online
Temperature 30 degrees C / 86 degrees F
...
CB 1 status
State Online
Temperature 30 degrees C / 86 degrees F
...
Other details, such as, temperature, power, etc are also displayed along with the state.
2. Verify that the fabric planes come online correctly by issuing the show chassis fabric
summary command:
3. Verify that the backup Routing Engine is back online by issuing the show chassis
routing-engine 1 command:
4. Verify the SCBE2-MXs before you finish by issuing the show chassis hardware
command:
Hardware inventory:
Item Version Part number Serial number Description
CB 0 REV 08 750-048307 CABC9829 Enhanced MX SCB 2
CB 1 REV 08 750-048307 CABC9828 Enhanced MX SCB 2
...
CAUTION: If you plug the Routing Engine into the SCBE3-MX without first
upgrading Junos to 18.4R1 or later, Junos might crash and go to a db prompt.
Should this occur, you’ll need to recover the router by copying the Junos
software image for the 18.4R1 or later release and then booting from the USB
drive to install 18.4R1 Junos on the SCBE3-MX. The USB install will wipe out
the router configuration and all user files on the Routing Engine.
To upgrade the Routing Engine while it’s plugged into an SCBE2-MX or older SCB:
2. If you have not already done so, connect to the console port on the switch from your
management device, and log in to the Junos OS CLI.
5. Reboot the Routing Engine and wait for it to boot with the new Routing Engine image.
CB 0 status
State Online
Temperature 30 degrees C / 86 degrees F
...
CB 1 status
State Online
Temperature 30 degrees C / 86 degrees F
...
Other details, such as, temperature, power, etc are also displayed along with the state.
Hardware inventory:
Item Version Part number Serial number Description
CB 0 REV 29 750-070866 CAKP0543 Enhanced MX SCB 3
CB 1 REV 29 750-070866 CAKP0541 Enhanced MX SCB 3
...
Action • Inspect the installation site for moisture, loose wires or cables, and excessive dust.
Make sure that airflow is unobstructed around the router and into the air intake vents.
• Check the status-reporting devices on the craft interface—System alarms and LEDs.
• Inspect the air filter at the left rear of the router, replacing it every 6 months for optimum
cooling system performance. Do not run the router for more than a few minutes without
the air filter in place.
Related • Tools and Parts Required to Maintain the MX960 Router on page 443
Documentation
• Maintaining the MX960 Air Filter on page 444
Maintaining Components
• Tools and Parts Required to Maintain the MX960 Router on page 443
• Maintaining the MX960 Air Filter on page 444
• Maintaining the MX960 Fan Trays on page 444
• Maintaining the MX960 Host Subsystem on page 446
• Maintaining MX960 DPCs on page 448
• Holding an MX960 DPC on page 450
• Storing an MX960 DPC on page 452
• Maintaining MX960 FPCs on page 453
• Holding an MX960 FPC on page 455
• Storing an MX960 FPC on page 459
• Maintaining MX960 MICs on page 460
• Maintaining MX960 MPCs on page 461
• Maintaining MX960 PICs on page 464
• Maintaining Cables That Connect to MX960 DPCs, MPCs, MICs, or PICs on page 465
• Maintaining the MX960 Power Supplies on page 466
• Verifying the Version of the MX960 Cable Manager on page 467
To maintain hardware components, you need the following tools and parts:
Related • Routine Maintenance Procedures for the MX960 Router on page 441
Documentation
• Maintaining the MX960 Host Subsystem on page 446
Purpose For optimum cooling, verify the condition of the air filters.
Action • Regularly inspect the air filter. A dirty air filter restricts airflow in the unit, producing a
negative effect on the ventilation of the chassis. The filter degrades over time. You
must replace the filter every 6 months.
CAUTION: Always keep the air filter in place while the device is operating.
Because the fans are very powerful, they could pull small bits of wire or
other materials into the through the unfiltered air intake. This could damage
the components.
• The shelf life of polyurethane filter varies from two years to five years depending on
the storage conditions. Store in a cool, dry, and dark environment. Wrap the media in
plastic and store in an environment with relative humidity between 40%- 80% and
temperature between 40° F (4° C) to 90° F (32° C). Note that if the material flakes,
or becomes brittle when rubbed or deformed, it is no longer usable.
Related • Tools and Parts Required to Maintain the MX960 Router on page 443
Documentation
• Replacing the MX960 Air Filter on page 321
Action • Monitor the status of the fans. A fan tray contains multiple fans that work in unison to
cool the router components. If one fan fails, the host subsystem adjusts the speed of
the remaining fans to maintain proper cooling. A red alarm is triggered when a fan fails,
and a yellow alarm and red alarm is triggered when a fan tray is removed.
• To display the status of the cooling system, issue the show chassis environment
command. The output is similar to the following:
NOTE: The fan numbers are stamped into the fan tray sheet metal next to
each fan.
Related • Tools and Parts Required to Maintain the MX960 Router on page 443
Documentation
• Replacing an MX960 Fan Tray on page 323
Purpose For optimum router performance, verify the condition of the host subsystem. The host
subsystem includes an SCB and a Routing Engine installed into a slot in the SCB.
• Check the LEDs on the craft interface to view information about the status of the
Routing Engines.
• Check the LEDs on the SCB faceplate (see Table 9 in “SCB-MX Description” on page 112).
• Check the LEDs on the Routing Engine faceplate (see Table 10 in “MX960 Routing
Engine Description” on page 26).
• To check the status of the Routing Engines, issue the show chassis routing-engine
command. The output is similar to the following:
• To check the status of the SCBs, issue the show chassis environment cb command.
The output is similar to the following:
CB 0 status:
State Online Master
Temperature 26 degrees C / 78 degrees F
Power 1
1.2 V 1202 mV
1.5 V 1508 mV
1.8 V 1830 mV
2.5 V 5053 mV
3.3 V 6593 mV
5.0 V 5111 mV
12.0 V 12181 mV
1.25 V 1263 mV
3.3 V SM3 6593 mV
5 V RE 5078 mV
12 V RE 12007 mV
Power 2
11.3 V bias PEM 11253 mV
To check the status of a specific SCB, issue the show chassis environment cb command
and include the slot number of the SCB—for example, show chassis environment cb 0.
For more information about using the CLI, see the Junos OS manuals.
Purpose The router can have up to 12 Dense Port Concentrators (DPCs) mounted vertically in the
DPC card cage at the front of the chassis. For optimum router performance, verify the
condition of the DPCs.
• Check the LEDs on the craft interface directly above each DPC slot. The green LED
labeled OK lights steadily when a DPC is functioning normally.
• Check the OK/FAIL LED on the DPC. For more information, see MX Series Interface
Module Reference. If the DPC detects a failure, the DPC sends an alarm message to the
Routing Engine.
• Check the status of installed DPCs by issuing the CLI show chassis fpc command to
check the status of installed DPCs. As shown in the sample output, the value Online
in the column labeled State indicates that the DPC is functioning normally:
For more detailed output, add the detail option. The following example does not specify
a slot number, which is optional:
Slot 2 information:
State Online
Temperature 22 degrees C / 71 degrees F
Total CPU DRAM 1024 MB
Total SRAM 256 MB
Total SDRAM 0 MB
Start time 2006-11-03 07:35:40 PST
Uptime 2 hours, 27 minutes, 1 second
Slot 4 information:
State Online
Temperature 22 degrees C / 71 degrees F
Total CPU DRAM 1024 MB
Total SRAM 256 MB
Total SDRAM 0 MB
Start time 2006-11-03 07:35:48 PST
Uptime 2 hours, 26 minutes, 53 seconds
Slot 7 information:
State Online
Temperature 24 degrees C / 75 degrees F
Total CPU DRAM 1024 MB
Total SRAM 256 MB
Total SDRAM 0 MB
Start time 2006-11-03 07:35:53 PST
Uptime 2 hours, 26 minutes, 48 seconds
• Issue the CLI show chassis fpc pic-status command. The DPC slots are numbered from
0 through 5, 2/6, 7 through 11, left to right:
For further description of the output from the command, see the CLI Explorer.
NOTE: A DPC weighs 14.5 lb (6.6 kg). Be prepared to accept the full weight
of the DPC as you lift it.
1. Orient the DPC so that the faceplate faces you. To verify orientation, confirm that the
text on the DPC is right-side up and the electromagnetic interference (EMI) strip is on
the right-hand side.
2. Place one hand around the DPC faceplate about a quarter of the way down from the
top edge. To avoid deforming the EMI shielding strip, do not press hard on it.
If the DPC is horizontal before you grasp it, place your left hand around the faceplate and
your right hand along the bottom edge.
2. Grasp the top edge with your left hand and the bottom edge with your right hand.
You can rest the faceplate of the DPC against your body as you carry it.
As you carry the DPC, do not bump it against anything. DPC components are fragile.
Never hold or grasp the DPC anywhere except places that this document indicates. In
particular, never grasp the connector edge, especially at the power connector in the
corner where the connector and bottom edges meet. See Figure 171 on page 451.
Never carry the DPC by the faceplate with only one hand.
Do not rest any edge of a DPC directly against a hard surface (see Figure 172 on page 452).
If you must rest the DPC temporarily on an edge while changing its orientation between
vertical and horizontal, use your hand as a cushion between the edge and the surface.
• In the router
When you store a DPC on a horizontal surface or in the shipping container, always place
it inside an antistatic bag. Because the DPC is heavy, and because antistatic bags are
fragile, inserting the DPC into the bag is easier with two people. To do this, one person
holds the DPC in the horizontal position with the faceplate facing the body, and the other
person slides the opening of the bag over the DPC connector edge.
If you must insert the DPC into a bag by yourself, first lay the DPC horizontally on a flat,
stable surface, sheet metal side down. Orient the DPC with the faceplate facing you.
Carefully insert the DPC connector edge into the opening of the bag, and pull the bag
toward you to cover the DPC.
Purpose The router can have one Flexible PIC Concentrator (FPC) installed vertically in two DPC
slots at the front of the chassis. For optimum router performance, verify the condition of
the FPC.
• Check the LEDs on the craft interface directly above the FPC. The green LED labeled
OK lights steadily when an FPC is functioning normally.
• Check the OK/FAIL LED on the FPC. If the FPC detects a failure, the FPC sends an alarm
message to the Routing Engine.
• Issue the CLI show chassis fpc command to check the status of the installed FPC. As
shown in the sample output, the value Online in the column labeled State indicates
that the FPC is functioning normally:
For more detailed output, add the detail option. The following example does not specify
a slot number, which is optional:
Slot 0 information:
State Online
Temperature 24 degrees C / 75 degrees F
Total CPU DRAM 1024 MB
Total RLDRAM 128 MB
Total DDR DRAM 2048 MB
Start time: 2008-12-11 16:53:24 PST
Uptime: 15 hours, 2 minutes, 47 seconds
Slot 2 information:
State Online
Temperature 29 degrees C / 84 degrees F
Total CPU DRAM 1024 MB
Total RLDRAM 256 MB
Total DDR DRAM 4096 MB
Start time: 2008-12-11 16:53:18 PST
Uptime: 15 hours, 2 minutes, 53 seconds
Slot 3 information:
State Online
Temperature 29 degrees C / 84 degrees F
Total CPU DRAM 1024 MB
Total RLDRAM 256 MB
Total DDR DRAM 4096 MB
Start time: 2008-12-11 16:53:18 PST
Uptime: 15 hours, 2 minutes, 53 seconds
Slot 4 information:
State Online
Temperature 29 degrees C / 84 degrees F
Total CPU DRAM 1024 MB
Total RLDRAM 256 MB
Total DDR DRAM 4096 MB
Start time: 2008-12-11 16:53:18 PST
Uptime: 15 hours, 2 minutes, 53 seconds
Slot 5 information:
State Online
Temperature 29 degrees C / 84 degrees F
Total CPU DRAM 1024 MB
Total RLDRAM 256 MB
Total DDR DRAM 4096 MB
Start time: 2008-12-11 16:53:22 PST
Uptime: 15 hours, 2 minutes, 49 seconds
Slot 6 information:
State Online
Temperature 29 degrees C / 84 degrees F
Total CPU DRAM 1024 MB
Total RLDRAM 256 MB
Total DDR DRAM 4096 MB
Start time: 2008-12-11 16:53:18 PST
Uptime: 15 hours, 2 minutes, 53 seconds
Slot 10 information:
State Online
Temperature 24 degrees C / 75 degrees F
Total CPU DRAM 1024 MB
Total RLDRAM 128 MB
Total DDR DRAM 2048 MB
Start time: 2008-12-11 16:53:24 PST
Uptime: 15 hours, 2 minutes, 47 seconds
• Issue the CLI show chassis fpc pic-status command. The following example shows an
FPC installed in DPC slots 1 and 2:
For further description of the output from the command, see the CLI Explorer.
CAUTION: Many components on the FPC are fragile. Failure to handle FPCs
as specified in this document can cause irreparable damage.
• As you carry the FPC, do not bump it against anything. FPC components
are fragile.
• Do not grasp the FPC anywhere except places that this document indicates.
In particular, never grasp the connector edge, especially at the power
connector in the corner where the connector and bottom edges meet (see
Figure 173 on page 456).
• Do not carry the FPC by the faceplate with only one hand (see
Figure 174 on page 457).
• Do not rest any edge of an FPC directly against a hard surface (see
Figure 175 on page 458). If you must rest the FPC temporarily on an edge
while changing its orientation between vertical and horizontal, use your
hand as a cushion between the edge and the surface.
You hold an FPC vertically when installing it into the chassis or an equipment rack. To
hold an FPC vertically (see Figure 176 on page 459):
2. Place one hand around the FPC faceplate about a quarter of the way down from the
top edge. To avoid deforming the electromagnetic interference (EMI) shielding strip,
do not press hard on it.
3. Place your other hand at the bottom edge of the FPC. If the FPC has heat sinks about
midway between the faceplate and connector edge, place your other hand against
the heat sinks.
When not installed in the routing platforms, FPCs must be either stored in the container
in which a spare FPC is shipped or stored horizontally with the component-side up on a
flat, stable surface. When you store an FPC on a horizontal surface or in the shipping
container, always place it inside an antistatic bag. Because the FPC is heavy and because
antistatic bags are fragile, inserting the FPC into the bag is easier with two people. The
storage guidelines are as follows:
• When storing an FPC with two people, one person holds the FPC in the horizontal
position with the faceplate facing their body, the other person slides the opening of
the bag over the FPC connector edge.
• When storing an FPC with one person, you must insert the FPC into a bag by yourself.
First lay the FPC horizontally on a flat, stable surface, component-side up. Orient the
FPC with the faceplate facing you. Carefully insert the FPC connector edge into the
opening of the bag, and pull the bag toward you to cover the FPC.
Purpose For optimum router performance, verify the condition of the Modular Interface Cards
(MICs).
• Check the LEDs on MIC faceplates. The meaning of the LED states differs for various
MICs. For more information, see the MX Series Interface Module Reference. If the MPC
that houses the MIC detects a MIC failure, the MPC generates an alarm message to be
sent to the Routing Engine.
• Issue the CLI show chassis fpc pic-status command. The MIC slots in an MPC are
numbered PIC 0/1 and PIC 2/3, top to bottom:
For further description of the output from the command, see the CLI Explorer.
Purpose The router can have up to 12 Modular Port Concentrators (MPCs) mounted vertically in
the card cage at the front of the chassis. For optimum router performance, verify the
condition of the MPCs.
• Check the LEDs on the craft interface directly above each MPC slot. The green LED
labeled OK lights steadily when an MPC is functioning normally.
• Check the OK/FAIL LED on the MPC. If the MPC detects a failure, the MPC sends an
alarm message to the Routing Engine.
• Issue the CLI show chassis fpc command to check the status of installed MPCs. As
shown in the sample output, the value Online in the column labeled State indicates
that the MPC is functioning normally:
For more detailed output, add the detail option. The following example does not specify
a slot number, which is optional:
Slot 0 information:
State Online
Temperature 33 degrees C / 91 degrees F
Total CPU DRAM 1024 MB
Total RLDRAM 256 MB
Total DDR DRAM 4096 MB
Start time: 2009-12-22 12:26:54 PST
Uptime: 6 days, 3 hours, 8 minutes, 51 seconds
• Issue the CLI show chassis fpc pic-status command. The MPC slots are numbered 0
through 5, bottom to top:
For further description of the output from the command, see the CLI Explorer.
Purpose For optimum router performance, verify the condition of the PICs.
• Check the LEDs on PIC faceplates. The meaning of the LED states differs for various
PICs. For more information, see the MX Series Interface Module Reference. If the FPC that
houses the PIC detects a PIC failure, the FPC generates an alarm message to be sent
to the Routing Engine.
• Issue the CLI show chassis fpc pic-status command. The PIC slots in an FPC are
numbered from 0 through 1, top to bottom:
For further description of the output from the command, see the CLI Explorer.
Purpose For optimum router performance, verify the condition of the cables that connect to the
DPCs, MPCs, MICs, or PICs.
Release handles
• Place excess cable out of the way in the standard or extended cable manager. Do not
allow fastened loops of cable to dangle from the connector or cable manager because
this stresses the cable at the fastening point. Putting fasteners on the loops helps to
maintain their shape.
• Keep the cable connections clean and free of dust and other particles, which can cause
drops in the received power level. Always inspect cables and clean them if necessary
before connecting an interface.
• When you unplug a fiber-optic cable, always place a rubber safety plug over the
transceiver on the faceplate and on the end of the cable.
• Anchor fiber-optic cables to avoid stress on the connectors. Be sure to secure fiber-optic
cables so that they do not support their own weight as they hang to the floor. Never
let fiber-optic cable hang free from the connector.
• Avoid bending fiber-optic cable beyond its bend radius. An arc smaller than a few
inches can damage the cable and cause problems that are difficult to diagnose.
• Frequent plugging and unplugging of fiber-optic cable into and out of optical
instruments can cause damage to the instruments that is expensive to repair. Instead,
attach a short fiber extension to the optical equipment. Any wear and tear due to
frequent plugging and unplugging is then absorbed by the short fiber extension, which
is easy and inexpensive to replace.
• Keep fiber-optic cable connections clean. Small microdeposits of oil and dust in the
canal of the transceiver or cable connector could cause loss of light, reducing signal
power and possibly causing intermittent problems with the optical connection.
After you clean an optical transceiver, make sure that the connector tip of the fiber-optic
cable is clean. Use only an approved alcohol-free fiber-optic cable cleaning kit, such
as the Opptex Cletop-S Fiber Cleaner. Follow the directions for the cleaning kit you
use.
Purpose For optimum router performance, verify the condition of the power supplies.
• Check the status of the power supplies by issuing the show chassis environment pem
command. The output is similar to the following:
PEM 0 status:
State Online
Temperature OK
DC output OK
PEM 1 status:
State Online
Temperature OK
DC output OK
• Make sure that the power and grounding cables are arranged so that they do not
obstruct access to other router components.
• Routinely check the status LEDs on the power supply faceplates and the craft interface
to determine if the power supplies are functioning normally.
• Check the red and yellow alarm LEDs on the craft interface. Power supply failure or
removal triggers an alarm that causes one or both of the LEDs to light. You can display
the associated error messages by issuing the following command:
• Periodically inspect the site to ensure that the grounding and power cables connected
to the router are securely in place and that there is no moisture accumulating near the
router.
Action Issue the show chassis hardware command. In the following output, Extended Cable
Manager in the Description field indicates that the MX960 router has an extended cable
manager installed.
Hardware inventory:
Item Version Part number Serial number Description
Chassis JN10BA496AFA MX960
Midplane REV 03 710-013698 TR0193 MX960 Backplane
Fan Extender REV 02 710-018051 JY5226 Extended Cable
Manager
FPM Board REV 03 710-014974 JZ6867 MX960 Front
Panel Display
PDM Rev 03 740-013110 QCS11035022 Power
Distribution Module
PEM 0 Rev 03 740-013683 QCS1104706T DC Power Entry
Module
PEM 1 Rev 03 740-013683 QCS11047071 DC Power Entry
Module
PEM 2 Rev 03 740-013683 QCS1110700A DC Power Entry
Module
PEM 3 Rev 03 740-013683 QCS11107006 DC Power Entry
Module
Routing Engine 0 REV 06 740-013063 1000690747 RE-S-2000
Routing Engine 1 REV 06 740-013063 1000690717 RE-S-2000
CB 0 REV 07 710-013385 KA3976 MX SCB
CB 1 REV 07 710-013385 KA2127 MX SCB
CB 2 REV 07 710-013385 KA2122 MX SCB
FPC 0 REV 06 710-013699 JZ8103 DPCE 40x 1GE X
CPU REV 06 710-013713 JZ7349 DPC PMB
PIC 0 BUILTIN BUILTIN 10x 1GE(LAN)
Xcvr 0 REV 01 740-011783 PB93302 SFP-LX
Xcvr 1 REV 01 740-011613 AM0703S02F5 SFP-SX
Xcvr 2 REV 01 740-011613 AM0703S02EV SFP-SX
Xcvr 3 REV 01 740-011613 AM0703S02EN SFP-SX
Xcvr 4 REV 01 740-011613 AM0703S02FD SFP-SX
Xcvr 5 REV 01 740-011783 PB93RLK SFP-LX
Xcvr 6 REV 01 740-011783 PB9292T SFP-LX
Xcvr 7 REV 01 740-011613 AM0703S02EC SFP-SX
Xcvr 8 REV 01 740-011783 PB9296B SFP-LX
Xcvr 9 REV 01 740-011783 PB9294X SFP-LX
PIC 1 BUILTIN BUILTIN 10x 1GE(LAN)
Xcvr 0 REV 01 740-011783 PB9330R SFP-LX
Xcvr 1 REV 01 740-011613 PB349PQ SFP-SX
Xcvr 2 REV 01 740-011613 AM0703S02F1 SFP-SX
Xcvr 3 REV 01 740-011613 PB3494J SFP-SX
Xcvr 4 REV 01 740-011613 AM0703S02EY SFP-SX
Xcvr 5 REV 01 740-011613 AM0703S02F3 SFP-SX
Xcvr 6 REV 01 740-011613 AM0703S02EX SFP-SX
Xcvr 7 REV 01 740-011613 AM0703S02EZ SFP-SX
Xcvr 8 REV 01 740-011613 AM0703S02ET SFP-SX
Xcvr 9 REV 01 740-011613 AM0703S02G8 SFP-SX
PIC 2 BUILTIN BUILTIN 10x 1GE(LAN)
Xcvr 0 REV 01 740-011783 PB92938 SFP-LX
Xcvr 1 REV 01 740-011613 AM0703S02E0 SFP-SX
Xcvr 2 REV 01 740-011613 AM0703S02F6 SFP-SX
Xcvr 3 REV 01 740-011613 AM0703S02FB SFP-SX
Xcvr 4 REV 01 740-011613 AM0703S02FA SFP-SX
Xcvr 5 REV 01 740-011613 AM0703S02ED SFP-SX
Xcvr 6 REV 01 740-011783 PB9338R SFP-LX
Xcvr 7 REV 01 740-011613 AM0703S02E1 SFP-SX
Xcvr 8 REV 01 740-011783 PB929AU SFP-LX
Xcvr 9 REV 01 740-011783 PB929AV SFP-LX
PIC 3 BUILTIN BUILTIN 10x 1GE(LAN)
Xcvr 0 REV 01 740-011783 PB9330Q SFP-LX
Xcvr 1 REV 01 740-011613 AM0703S02E8 SFP-SX
Xcvr 2 REV 01 740-011613 PB34FPU SFP-SX
Xcvr 3 REV 01 740-011613 PB34FZ4 SFP-SX
Xcvr 4 REV 01 740-011613 PB34N3Q SFP-SX
Xcvr 5 REV 01 740-011613 AM0703S02EL SFP-SX
Xcvr 6 REV 01 740-011613 AM0703S02EG SFP-SX
Xcvr 7 REV 01 740-011613 AM0703S02EJ SFP-SX
Use the following procedures to install the MX960 high capacity DC power supplies for
power supply in slots 0, 1, 2, 3 where present.
1. Move the AC input switch in the chassis above the power supply in slot 0 to the off
(O) position.
2. Remove the power cord from the AC power source. Follow the ESD and disconnection
instructions for your site.
4. While grasping the handle on the power supply faceplate with one hand, use your
other hand to pull the spring-loaded locking pin in the release lever away from the
chassis and turn the release lever counterclockwise until it stops.
5. Let go of the locking pin in the release lever. Ensure that the pin is seated inside the
corresponding hole in the chassis.
6. Pull the power supply straight out of the chassis as shown in Figure 161 on page 399.
WARNING: Do not touch the power connector on the top of the power
supply. It can contain dangerous voltages.
Use the following procedures to install the MX960 high-capacity DC power supplies for
power supply in slots 0, 1, 2, and 3, where present.
1. Verify that the power switch on the power supply is in the off (O) position.
2. On the power supply, rotate the metal cover away from the input mode switch to
expose the switch.
3. Move the input mode switch to position 0 for one feed or position 1 for two feeds (see
Figure 71 on page 227).
1
0
g006062
CAUTION: Do not use a pencil, because fragments can break off and cause
damage to the power supply.
4. Ensure that the voltage across the DC power source cable leads is 0 V and that there
is no chance that the cable leads might become active during installation.
5. Ensure that the release lever below the empty power supply slot is locked in the
counterclockwise position.
If necessary, pull the spring-loaded locking pin in the release lever away from the
chassis and turn the release lever counterclockwise until it stops. Let go of the locking
pin in the release lever. Ensure that the pin is seated inside the corresponding hole in
the chassis.
6. Using both hands, slide the power supply straight into the chassis until the power
supply is fully seated in the chassis slot.
The small tab on the metal housing that is controlled by the release lever must be
inside of the corresponding slot at the bottom of the power supply. This tab is used
to pull the power supply down in the chassis slot, prior to removing the power supply.
7. While firmly pushing the handle on the power supply faceplate with one hand, use
your other hand to pull the spring-loaded locking pin in the release lever away from
the chassis and turn the release lever clockwise until it stops.
8. Let go of the locking pin in the release lever. Ensure that the pin is seated inside the
corresponding hole in the chassis.
10. Remove the nut and washer from each of the terminal studs.
11. Secure each power cable lug to the terminal studs, first with the split washer, then
with the nut. Apply between 23 lb-in. (2.6 Nm) and 25 lb-in. (2.8 Nm) of torque to
each nut. Do not overtighten the nut. (Use a 7/16-in. [11-mm] torque-controlled driver
or socket wrench.)
a. On INPUT 0, attach the positive (+) DC source power cable lug to the RTN (return)
terminal as shown in Figure 71 on page 227. Repeat this step for INPUT 1 if using two
feeds.
b. On INPUT 0 attach the negative (–) DC source power cable lug to the -48V (input)
terminal. Repeat this step for INPUT 1 if using two feeds.if using two feeds.
CAUTION: Ensure that each power cable lug seats flush against the surface
of the terminal block as you are tightening the nuts. Ensure that each nut
is properly threaded onto the terminal stud. The nut should be able to spin
freely with your fingers when it is first placed onto the terminal stud.
Applying installation torque to the nut when improperly threaded may
result in damage to the terminal stud.
NOTE: The DC power supplies in slots PEM0 and PEM1 must be powered
by dedicated power feeds derived from feed A, and the DC power supplies
in PEM2 and PEM3 must be powered by dedicated power feeds derived
from feed B. This configuration provides the commonly deployed A/B feed
redundancy for the system. For information about connecting to DC power
sources, see “Electrical Specifications for the MX960 DC Power Supply”
on page 159.
12. Verify that the power cabling is correct, that the cables are not touching, and that they
do not block access to router components or drape where people could trip on them.
13. Replace the clear plastic cover over the terminal studs on the faceplate.
15. Verify that the INPUT 0 OK or INPUT 1 OK LEDs on the power supply are lit green
steadily. If using two feeds, verify that both INPUT 0 OK and INPUT 1 OK LEDs on the
power supply are lit steadily. The INPUT OK will be lit amber if that input’s voltage is
in reverse polarity. Check the polarity of the power cables to fix the condition (see
Figure 72 on page 230 and Table 83 on page 229.
17. Verify that the DC OK LED is lit green steadily. See Table 83 on page 229 for information
on MX960 high-capacity DC LEDs.
DIP LEDs
Switch
Connected Inputs Position INP-0 OK INP-1 OK DC OK PS FAIL
DIP LEDs
Switch
Connected Inputs Position INP-0 OK INP-1 OK DC OK PS FAIL
18. Repeat steps 1-17 for installing power supplies in slots 1, 2, and 3, where present.
19. Install a blank panel over the power distribution modules, if available.
1. Switch off the dedicated customer site circuit breaker for the power supply being
removed. Follow your site's procedures for electrostatic discharge (ESD).
2. Move the DC circuit breaker on the power supply faceplate to the off (O) position.
3. Verify that the INPUT OK LEDs on the power supply to be removed are not lit. Also
verify that the BREAKER ON LED is not lit.
4. Make sure that the voltage across the DC power source cable leads is 0 V and that
there is no chance that the cables might become active during the removal process.
5. Remove the clear plastic cover protecting the terminal studs on the faceplate from
the power supply in slot 0.
6. Remove the nut and washer from each of the terminal studs. (Use a 7/16-in.
[11-mm] nut driver or socket wrench.)
7. Loosen the captive screw on the cable restraint on the lower edge of the power supply
faceplate.
10. While grasping the handle on the power supply faceplate with one hand, use your
other hand to pull the spring-loaded locking pin in the release lever away from the
chassis and turn the release lever counterclockwise until it stops.
11. Let go of the locking pin in the release lever. Ensure that the pin is seated inside the
corresponding hole in the chassis.
12. Pull the power supply straight out of the chassis (see Figure 164 on page 404).
WARNING: Do not touch the power connector on the top of the power
supply. It can contain dangerous voltages.
13. Repeat steps 1-12 for power supplies in slot 1, 2, and 3, where present.
Use the following procedures to install the MX960 high-capacity AC power supplies for
power supply in slots 0, 1, 2, and 3, where present.
To install an MX960 high-capacity AC power supply, use the following procedure (see
Figure 68 on page 219).
1. Verify that the power switch on the power supply is in the off (O) position.
2. Ensure that the release lever below the empty power supply slot is locked in the
counterclockwise position (see Figure 68 on page 219).
Air exhaust
PS FAIL AC-2 OK
DC OK AC-1 OK
PS FAIL AC-2 OK
DC OK AC-1 OK
PS FAIL AC-2 OK
DC OK
PS FAIL
AC Power
supplies
Power supply
ejectors
g006061
Protective earthing ESD point
If necessary, pull the spring-loaded locking pin in the release lever away from the
chassis and turn the release lever counterclockwise until it stops. Let go of the locking
pin in the release lever. Ensure that the pin is seated inside the corresponding hole in
the chassis.
3. On the power supply, rotate the metal cover away from the input mode switch to
expose the switch.
4. Move the input mode switch to position 0 for one feed or position 1 for two feeds (see
Figure 69 on page 220).
1
0 1
0
g006057
CAUTION: Do not use a pencil, because fragments can break off and cause
damage to the power supply.
5. Using both hands, slide the power supply straight into the chassis until the power
supply is fully seated in the chassis slot. The power supply faceplate will protrude
beyond the chassis.
The small tab on the metal housing that is controlled by the release lever must be
inside of the corresponding slot at the bottom of the power supply (see
Figure 69 on page 220). This tab is used to pull the power supply down in the chassis
slot, prior to removing the power supply.
6. While firmly pushing the handle on the power supply faceplate with one hand, use
your other hand to pull the spring-loaded locking pin in the release lever away from
the chassis and turn the release lever clockwise until it stops.
7. Let go of the locking pin in the release lever. Ensure that the pin is seated inside the
corresponding hole in the chassis.
8. Locate a power cord with the type of plug appropriate for your geographical location
(see “AC Power Cord Specifications for the MX960 Router” on page 156).
9. Plug the power cord into the corresponding appliance inlet located in the chassis
directly above the power supply. This is the recommend receptacle when using the
power supply in one feed mode. If using the power supply in two-feed mode, plug the
second power cord into the receptacle on the power supply.
10. Dress the power cord appropriately. Verify that the power cord does not block the air
exhaust and access to router components, and that they do not drape where people
could trip on them.
11. Move the AC input switch above the power supply to the on (—) position. This is the
only switch you have to turn on if you are using the power supply in one feed mode. If
using the power supply in two-feed mode, move the power switch on the power supply
to the on position. Remember to turn on both switches when operating the power
supply in two-feed mode.
12. If the power supply is correctly installed and functioning normally, the AC1 OK, AC2 OK
(two-feed mode only), and DC OK LEDs light steadily, and the PS FAIL LED is not lit.
See Table 82 on page 221.
13. Repeat steps 1-12 for installing power supplies in slots 1, 2, and 3, where present
LEDs
Connected DIP Switch
Inputs Position AC-1 OK AC-2 OK DC OK PS FAIL
NOTE: PDM in the above table stands for Power Distribution Module.
Troubleshooting Hardware
• Troubleshooting Components on page 485
Troubleshooting Components
Command-Line Interface
The Junos OS command-line interface (CLI) is the primary tool for controlling and
troubleshooting router hardware, the Junos OS, routing protocols, and network
connectivity. CLI commands display information from routing tables, information specific
to routing protocols, and information about network connectivity derived from the ping
and traceroute utilities.
You enter CLI commands on one or more external management devices connected to
ports on the Routing Engine.
For information about using the CLI to troubleshoot the Junos OS, see the appropriate
Junos OS configuration guide.
• Alarm LEDs—One large red circular LED and one large yellow triangular LED, located
on the upper right of the craft interface, indicate two levels of alarm conditions. The
circular red LED lights to indicate a critical condition that can result in a system
shutdown. The triangular yellow LED lights to indicate a less severe condition that
requires monitoring or maintenance. Both LEDs can be lit simultaneously. A condition
that causes an alarm LED to light also activates the corresponding alarm relay contact
on the craft interface.
• Host subsystem LEDs—Three LEDs, MASTER, ONLINE, and OFFLINE, indicate the status
of the host subsystem. A green MASTER LED indicates that the host is functioning as
the master. The ONLINE LED indicates that the host is online. The OFFLINE LED indicates
that the host is installed but the routing engine is offline. The host subsystem LEDs are
located on the left of the craft interface and are labeled RE0 and RE1.
• Power supply LEDs—Two LEDs (PEM) indicate the status of each power supply. Green
indicates that the power supply is functioning normally. Red indicates that the power
supply is not functioning normally. The power supply LEDs are located in the center
craft interface, and are labeled 0 through 3.
• Line card LEDs—Two LEDs, OK and FAIL, indicate the status of each DPC, FPC, or MPC.
Green indicates OK and red indicates a failure. The line card LEDs are located along
the bottom of the craft interface.
• SCB LEDs—Two LEDs, OK and FAIL, indicate the status of each SCB. Green indicates
OK and red indicates a failure. The SCB LEDs are located on the left of the craft interface
along the bottom.
• Fan LEDs—Two LEDs indicate the status of the fans. Green indicates the fans are
functioning normally and red indicates a fan has failed. The fan LEDs are located on
the upper left of the craft interface.
Component LEDs
The following LEDs are located on various router components and display the status of
those components:
• DPC LED—One LED labeled OK/FAIL on each DPC faceplate indicates the DPC's status.
For more information, see the MX Series Interface Module Reference.
• FPC LED—One LED labeled OK/FAIL on each FPC faceplate indicates the FPC's status.
• MPC LED—One LED labeled OK/FAIL on each FPC faceplate indicates the FPC's status.
• MIC LED—One LED labeled OK/FAIL on each MIC faceplate indicates the MIC's status.
For more information, see the MX Series Interface Module Reference.
• PIC LED—One LED labeled OK/FAIL on each PIC faceplate indicates the PIC's status.
For more information, see the MX Series Interface Module Reference.
• SCB LEDs—Three LEDs, labeled FABRIC ACTIVE, FABRIC ONLY, and OK/FAIL, on each
SCB faceplate indicate the status of the SCB. If no LEDs are lit, the master RE might
still be booting or the SCB is not receiving power.
• Routing Engine LEDs—Four LEDs, labeled MASTER, HDD, ONLINE, and FAIL on each
Routing Engine faceplate indicate the status of the Routing Engine and hard disk drive.
• Power supply LEDs—Two LEDs on each power supply faceplate indicate the status of
that power supply.
Problem Description: The fans in a fan tray are not functioning normally.
• Check the fan LEDs and alarm LEDs on the craft interface.
• If the red alarm LED on the craft interface lights, use the CLI to get information about
the source of an alarm condition: user@host> show chassis alarms.
If the CLI output lists only one fan failure, and the other fans are functioning normally,
the fan is most likely faulty and you must replace the fan tray.
• Place your hand near the exhaust vents at the side of the chassis to determine whether
the fans are pushing air out of the chassis.
• The following conditions automatically cause the fans to run at full speed and also
trigger the indicated alarm:
• The router temperature exceeds the “temperature warm” threshold (yellow alarm).
• The temperature of the router exceeds the maximum (“temperature hot”) threshold
(red alarm and automatic shutdown of the power supplies).
Related • MX960 Alarm LEDs and Alarm Cutoff/Lamp Test Button on page 15
Documentation
• Replacing an MX960 Fan Tray on page 323
Solution • Monitor the green LED labeled OK above the DPC on the craft interface as soon as a
DPC is seated in an operating router.
The Routing Engine downloads the DPC software to it under two conditions: the DPC
is present when the Routing Engine boots Junos OS, and the DPC is installed and
requested online through the CLI or push button on the front panel. The DPC then runs
diagnostics, during which the OK LED blinks. When the DPC is online and functioning
normally, the OK LED lights green steadily.
• Make sure the DPC is properly seated in the midplane. Check that each ejector handle
has been turned clockwise and is tight.
• Check the OK/FAIL LED on the DPC and OK and FAIL DPC LEDs on the craft interface.
When the DPC is online and functioning normally, the OK LED lights green steadily.
• Issue the show chassis fpc command to check the status of installed DPCs. As shown
in the sample output, the value Online in the column labeled State indicates that the
DPC is functioning normally:
NOTE: The show chassis fpc command displays the status of the DPCs.
For more detailed output, add the detail option. The following example does not specify
a slot number, which is optional:
Slot 2 information:
State Online
Temperature 22 degrees C / 71 degrees F
Total CPU DRAM 1024 MB
Total SRAM 256 MB
Total SDRAM 0 MB
Start time 2006-11-03 07:35:40 PST
Uptime 2 hours, 27 minutes, 1 second
Slot 4 information:
State Online
Temperature 22 degrees C / 71 degrees F
Total CPU DRAM 1024 MB
Total SRAM 256 MB
Total SDRAM 0 MB
Start time 2006-11-03 07:35:48 PST
Uptime 2 hours, 26 minutes, 53 seconds
Slot 7 information:
State Online
Temperature 24 degrees C / 75 degrees F
Total CPU DRAM 1024 MB
Total SRAM 256 MB
Total SDRAM 0 MB
Start time 2006-11-03 07:35:53 PST
Uptime 2 hours, 26 minutes, 48 seconds
For further description of the output from the commands, see the Junos OS
Administration Library.
Solution • Monitor the green LED labeled OK above the FPC on the craft interface as soon as an
FPC is seated in an operating router.
The Routing Engine downloads the FPC software to it under two conditions: the FPC
is present when the Routing Engine boots Junos OS, and the FPC is installed and
requested online through the CLI or push button on the front panel. The FPC then runs
diagnostics, during which the OK LED blinks. When the FPC is online and functioning
normally, the OK LED lights green steadily.
• Make sure the FPC is properly seated in the midplane. Check that each ejector handle
has been turned clockwise and is tight.
• Check the OK/FAIL LED on the FPC and OK and FAIL FPC LEDs on the craft interface.
When the FPC is online and functioning normally, the OK LED lights green steadily.
• Issue the show chassis fpc command to check the status of installed FPCs. As shown
in the sample output, the value Online in the column labeled State indicates that the
FPC is functioning normally:
9 Empty
10 Online 24 3 0 1024 13 21
11 Empty
NOTE: The show chassis fpc command displays the status of the FPCs.
For more detailed output, add the detail option. The following example does not specify
a slot number, which is optional:
Slot 0 information:
State Online
Temperature 24 degrees C / 75 degrees F
Total CPU DRAM 1024 MB
Total RLDRAM 128 MB
Total DDR DRAM 2048 MB
Start time: 2008-12-11 16:53:24 PST
Uptime: 15 hours, 2 minutes, 47 seconds
Slot 2 information:
State Online
Temperature 29 degrees C / 84 degrees F
Total CPU DRAM 1024 MB
Total RLDRAM 256 MB
Total DDR DRAM 4096 MB
Start time: 2008-12-11 16:53:18 PST
Uptime: 15 hours, 2 minutes, 53 seconds
Slot 3 information:
State Online
Temperature 29 degrees C / 84 degrees F
Total CPU DRAM 1024 MB
Total RLDRAM 256 MB
Total DDR DRAM 4096 MB
Start time: 2008-12-11 16:53:18 PST
Uptime: 15 hours, 2 minutes, 53 seconds
Slot 4 information:
State Online
Temperature 29 degrees C / 84 degrees F
Total CPU DRAM 1024 MB
Total RLDRAM 256 MB
Total DDR DRAM 4096 MB
Start time: 2008-12-11 16:53:18 PST
Uptime: 15 hours, 2 minutes, 53 seconds
Slot 5 information:
State Online
Temperature 29 degrees C / 84 degrees F
Total CPU DRAM 1024 MB
Total RLDRAM 256 MB
Total DDR DRAM 4096 MB
Start time: 2008-12-11 16:53:22 PST
Uptime: 15 hours, 2 minutes, 49 seconds
Slot 6 information:
State Online
Temperature 29 degrees C / 84 degrees F
Total CPU DRAM 1024 MB
For further description of the output from the commands, see the Junos OS
Administration Library.
Solution • Check the status of each port on a PIC by looking at the LED located on the PIC
faceplate. For information about the meaning of LED states on different PICs, see the
MX Series Interface Module Reference.
• Check the status of a PIC by issuing the show chassis fpc pic-status CLI command. The
PIC slots in the FPC are numbered from 0 through 1, top to bottom:
For further description of the output from the command, see the CLI Explorer.
Solution • Check the status of each port on a MIC by looking at the LED located on the MIC
faceplate. For information about the meaning of LED states on different MICs, see the
MX Series Ethernet Services Routers Line Card Guide.
• Check the status of a MIC by issuing the show chassis fpc pic-status CLI command. The
MIC slots in the MPC are labeled PIC 0/1 and PIC 2/3, top to bottom:
For further description of the output from the command, see the CLI Explorer.
Solution • Monitor the green LED labeled OK above the MPC on the craft interface as soon as an
MPC is seated in an operating router.
The Routing Engine downloads the MPC software to it under two conditions: The MPC
is present when the Routing Engine boots Junos OS, and the MPC is installed and
requested online through the CLI or push button on the front panel. The MPC then runs
diagnostics, during which the OK LED blinks. When the MPC is online and functioning
normally, the OK LED lights green steadily.
• Make sure the MPC is properly seated in the midplane. Check that each ejector handle
has been turned clockwise and is tight.
• Check the OK/FAIL LED on the MPC and OK and FAIL line card LEDs on the craft
interface. When the MPC is online and functioning normally, the OK LED lights green
steadily.
• Issue the show chassis fpc command to check the status of installed MPCs. As shown
in the sample output, the value Online in the column labeled State indicates that the
MPC is functioning normally:
NOTE: The show chassis fpc command displays the status of the MPCs.
For more detailed output, add the detail option. The following example does not specify
a slot number, which is optional:
Slot 0 information:
State Online
Temperature 33 degrees C / 91 degrees F
Total CPU DRAM 1024 MB
Total RLDRAM 256 MB
Total DDR DRAM 4096 MB
Start time: 2009-12-22 12:26:54 PST
Uptime: 6 days, 3 hours, 8 minutes, 51 seconds
Slot 10 information:
State Online
Temperature 24 degrees C / 75 degrees F
Total CPU DRAM 1024 MB
Total RLDRAM 128 MB
Total DDR DRAM 2048 MB
Start time: 2008-12-11 16:53:24 PST
Uptime: 15 hours, 2 minutes, 47 seconds
Max Power Consumption 440 Watts
For further description of the output from the commands, see the Junos OS
Administration Library.
• Issue the CLI show chassis environment pem command to check the status of installed
power supply modules. As shown in the sample output, the value Online in the rows
labeled State indicates that each power supply is functioning normally:
PEM 0 status:
State Online
Temperature OK
DC output OK
PEM 1 status:
State Online
Temperature OK
DC output OK
If a power supply is not functioning normally, perform the following steps to diagnose
and correct the problem:
• If a red alarm condition occurs, issue the show chassis alarms command to determine
the source of the problem.
• Check that the AC input switch (—) or DC circuit breaker (|) is in the on position and
that the power supply is receiving power.
• Verify that the source circuit breaker has the proper current rating. Each power supply
must be connected to a separate source circuit breaker.
• Verify that the AC power cord or DC power cables from the power source to the router
are not damaged. If the insulation is cracked or broken, immediately replace the cord
or cable.
• Connect the power supply to a different power source with a new power cord or power
cables. If the power supply status LEDs indicate that the power supply is not operating
normally, the power supply is the source of the problem. Replace the power supply
with a spare.
• If all power supplies have failed, the system temperature might have exceeded the
threshold, causing the system to shut down.
The Junos OS also can shut down one of the power supplies for other
reasons. In this case, the remaining power supplies provide power to the
router, and you can still view the system status through the CLI or display.
1. Move the power switch on the power supply to the off (o) position.
2. Turn off power to where the AC line goes into the power distribution module (PDM)
area.
3. Wait for the power supply LEDs to fade out and for the fans inside the power supply
to shutdown. This can take up to 10 seconds.
4. Turn on power to where the AC line goes into the power distribution module (PDM)
area.
5. Move the power switch on the power supply to the on (|) position.
6. Verify that the LEDs on the power supply faceplate are properly lit.
7. Issue the CLI show chassis environment pem command and verify the State is ONLINE
and the Temperature is OK.
1. Switch off the circuit breaker(s) on the DC distribution panel to remove power to
the chassis and power supplies.
2. Switch on the circuit breaker(s) on the distribution panel to power up the chassis
and power supplies.
NOTE: The power switch on the power supplies is not part of the outer
or inner DC circuits and therefore does not need to be switched off when
restarting the chassis.
Each High Capacity AC or DC power supply accepts two AC or DC feeds in two unique
AC or DC receptacles. It is possible to operate with one feed, but there is a reduction in
the power supply output. The DIP switch must be set according to the number of AC or
DC feeds that are present for the power supply.
1
0 1
0
g006057
• Position – 0 indicates that only one AC or DC feed is provided.
1. Issue the show chassis power command and check to see how many feeds are
connected. The following example shows there are two AC input feeds connected
for PEM 0 and one AC input feed connected for PEM 1. This indicates that the DIP
switch for PEM 0 is in position 1 and the DIP switch for PEM 1 is in position 0. These
are the proper settings.
PEM 0:
State: Online
AC input: OK (2 feed expected, 2 feed connected)
Capacity: 4100 W (maximum 4100 W)
DC output: 855 W (zone 0, 15 A at 57 V, 20% of capacity)
PEM 1:
State: Online
AC input: OK (1 feed expected, 1 feed connected)
Capacity: 1700 W (maximum 4100 W)
DC output: 969 W (zone 1, 17 A at 57 V, 57% of capacity)
2. Issue the show chassis alarms command to see if there are any active alarms on the
DIP switch:
3. If the show chassis alarms output shows an alarm on Dipswitch, issue the show chassis
power command to check the DIP switch position.
PEM 0:
State: Online
AC input: OK (1 feed expected, 2 feed connected)
Capacity: 4100 W (maximum 4100 W)
DC output: 855 W (zone 0, 15 A at 57 V, 20% of capacity)
In this example, the DIP switch is in the wrong position since there is one AC feed
expected but two AC feeds are connected. Change the DIP switch to position 1. This
should clear the alarm.
NOTE: Changing the DIP switch position does not impact traffic. However,
it is always recommended to do so in a maintenance window.
You can contact Juniper Networks Technical Assistance Center (JTAC) 24 hours a day,
7 days a week in one of the following ways:
https://support.juniper.net/support/
• By telephone:
When requesting support from JTAC by telephone, be prepared to provide the following
information:
• Type of activity being performed on the device when the problem occurred
• Your name, organization name, telephone number, fax number, and shipping address
The support representative validates your request and issues an RMA number for return
of the component.
Hardware inventory:
Item Version Part number Serial number Description
Chassis JN107FC5DAFA MX960
Midplane REV 02 710-013698 CC6220 MX960 Midplane
FPM Board REV 01 710-014974 JS4208 MX960 Front Panel Displ
ay
PIM Rev 02 740-013110 QCS10375009 Power Inlet Module
PEM 0 Rev 01 740-013682 QCS10374009 PS 1.7kW; 200-240VAC in
PEM 1 Rev 01 740-013682 QCS10374029 PS 1.7kW; 200-240VAC in
Routing Engine 0 REV 02 740-013063 1000639065 RE-S-2000
Routing Engine 1 REV 04 740-013063 1000664335 RE-S-2000
CB 0 REV 02.6 710-013385 JM7908 MX960 SCB
CB 1 REV 03 710-013385 JS9412 MX960 SCB
Most components also have a small rectangular serial number ID label (see
Figure 187 on page 507) attached to the component body.
The serial number label is located on the left side of the top of the Routing Engine (see
Figure 188 on page 507 and Figure 189 on page 508).
AAAA0000
g004063
The chassis serial number is located on the side of the chassis (see Figure 190 on page 509).
0
MASTER
1 YELL
OW ALAR
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE M RED ALAR
M
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
g004064
Related • Displaying MX960 Router Components and Serial Numbers on page 505
Documentation
• MX960 Craft Interface Serial Number Label on page 509
The serial number is located on the back of the craft interface panel (see
Figure 191 on page 510).
AA1234
0
MASTER
1 YELLOW ALARM
PEM 0 1 2 3 ONLINE RED ALARM
g004094
OK FAIL FAN ACO/LT
OK FAIL OFFLINE
OK FAIL OK FAIL
OK FAIL RE0
OK FAIL RE1 NC C NO
OK FAIL NC C NO
0 1 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
2 3 OK FAIL
OK FAIL
ONLINE 4 OK FAIL
ONLINE 5
ONLINE 0 OK FAIL
ONLINE 1 OK FAIL
ONLINE
ONLINE 2 6 7
ONLINE 8
ONLINE
ONLINE 9 10
ONLINE
ONLINE 11
ONLINE
ONLINE
ONLINE
The serial number is located on the top left-hand corner of the fan tray, near the captive
thumbscrew (see Figure 192 on page 510).
AA1234 g006010
The serial number label is located on the AC power supply faceplate under the on/off
switch (see Figure 193 on page 511).
The serial number label is located on the DC power supply faceplate under the circuit
breaker switch (see Figure 194 on page 511).
The serial number label location varies per MIC (see Figure 196 on page 512 and
Figure 197 on page 513). The exact location may be slightly different on different MICs,
depending on the placement of components on the MIC board (see Figure 195 on page 512,
Figure 196 on page 512, Figure 197 on page 513, and Figure 198 on page 513).
Figure 195: 2-Port MIC Serial Number Label Figure 196: 4-Port MIC Serial Number Label
g004931
g004930
Serial number
Serial number
ID label
ID label
Figure 197: 20-Port MIC Serial Number Label Figure 198: 40-Port MIC Serial Number Label
Serial
number
ID label
g004932
g004933
Serial number
ID label
The serial number label is near the connectors located on the left side of the MPC when
it is oriented vertically (see Figure 199 on page 514).
MX-MPC1-3D-Q
OK/Fail
Serial number ID
label (yellow, on
opposite side)
g004927
The serial number label is located on the right side of the PIC (see Figure 200 on page 515),
when the PIC is vertically oriented (as it would be installed in the router). The exact
location may be slightly different on different PICs, depending on the placement of
components on the PIC board.
The serial number label is located on the center of the right side of the FPC (see
Figure 201 on page 516).
AA1234
g004410
The serial number label is located on the center of the right side of the DPC (see
Figure 202 on page 517).
OK/FAIL
Serial number
0/0
TUNNEL
LINK
ID label
AA567 8
1/0
TUNNEL
LINK
2/0
TUNNEL
LINK
g004067
3/0
TUNNEL
LINK
The serial number is located on the right side of the top of the SCB (see
Figure 203 on page 518).
g004068
Serial number
ID label
You can contact Juniper Networks Technical Assistance Center (JTAC) 24 hours a day,
7 days a week in one of the following ways:
https://support.juniper.net/support/
• By telephone:
When requesting support from JTAC by telephone, be prepared to provide the following
information:
• Type of activity being performed on the device when the problem occurred
• Your name, organization name, telephone number, fax number, and shipping address
The support representative validates your request and issues an RMA number for return
of the component.
If you are returning a device or hardware component to Juniper Networks for repair or
replacement, obtain a Return Material Authorization (RMA) number from Juniper Networks
Technical Assistance Center (JTAC).
After locating the serial number of the device or hardware component you want to return,
open a service request with Juniper Networks Technical Assistance Center (JTAC) on
the Web or by telephone.
Before you request an RMA number from JTAC, be prepared to provide the following
information:
• Your name, organization name, telephone number, fax number, and shipping address
• Type of activity being performed on the device when the problem occurred
You can contact JTAC 24 hours a day, seven days a week on the Web or by telephone:
If you are contacting JTAC by telephone, enter your 12-digit service request number
followed by the pound (#) key for an existing case, or press the star (*) key to be routed
to the next available support engineer.
The support representative validates your request and issues an RMA number for return
of the component.
• When you return components, make sure that they are adequately protected with
packing materials and packed so that the pieces are prevented from moving around
inside the carton.
• Write the RMA number on the exterior of the box to ensure proper tracking.
1. Retrieve the shipping crate and packing materials in which the router was originally
shipped. If you do not have these materials, contact your Juniper Networks
representative about approved packaging materials.
2. On the console or other management device connected to the master Routing Engine,
enter CLI operational mode and issue the following command to shut down the router
software. (If two Routing Engines are installed, also issue the command on the backup
Routing Engine.)
Wait until a message appears on the console confirming that the operating system
has halted.
For more information about the command, see request system halt.
3. Attach an ESD grounding strap to your bare wrist and connect the strap to one of the
ESD points on the chassis.
4. Shut down power to the router by pressing the AC input switch or DC circuit breaker
for all power supplies to the off (O) position.
• If you are using a mechanical lift, place the lift platform under the router, unscrew
and remove the mounting screws from the rack, and move the router to the shipping
crate.
• If you are not using a mechanical lift and the router weight is fully supported by a
shelf or another router, unscrew and remove the mounting screws from the rack.
Three people can then lift the router and move it to the shipping crate.
• If you are not using a mechanical lift and the router weight is not fully supported by
a shelf or another router, three people should grasp the router while a fourth person
unscrews and removes the mounting screws from the rack. The three lifters can
then move the router to the shipping container.
9. Place the router in the shipping crate or onto the pallet. If on a pallet, bolt the router
to the pallet.
10. Cover the router with an ESD bag and place the packing foam on top of and around
the router.
12. Securely tape the box closed or place the crate cover over the router.
13. Write the RMA number on the exterior of the box to ensure proper tracking.
If a hardware component fails, please contact Juniper Networks, Inc. to obtain a Return
Material Authorization (RMA) number. This number is used to track the returned material
at the factory and to return repaired or new components to the customer as needed.
NOTE: Do not return any component to Juniper Networks, Inc. unless you
have first obtained an RMA number. Juniper Networks, Inc. reserves the right
to refuse shipments that do not have an RMA. Refused shipments are returned
to the customer by collect freight.
For more information about return and repair policies, see the customer support webpage
at https://support.juniper.net/support/.
For product problems or technical support issues, contact the Juniper Networks Technical
Assistance Center (JTAC) by using the Service Request Manager link at
https://support.juniper.net/support/ or at 1-888-314-JTAC (within the United States) or
1-408-745-9500 (from outside the United States).
1. Determine the part number and serial number of the defective component.
2. Obtain an RMA number from the Juniper Networks Technical Assistance Center (JTAC).
You can send e-mail or telephone as described above.
3. Provide the following information in your e-mail message or during the telephone call:
4. The support representative validates your request and issues an RMA number for
return of the component.
• Perform only the procedures explicitly described in the hardware documentation for
this device. Make sure that only authorized service personnel perform other system
services.
• Keep the area around the device clear and free from dust before, during, and after
installation.
• Keep tools away from areas where people could trip over them while walking.
• Do not wear loose clothing or jewelry, such as rings, bracelets, or chains, which could
become caught in the device.
• Wear safety glasses if you are working under any conditions that could be hazardous
to your eyes.
• Do not perform any actions that create a potential hazard to people or make the
equipment unsafe.
• Never attempt to lift an object that is too heavy for one person to handle.
• Never install electrical jacks in wet locations unless the jacks are specifically designed
for wet environments.
• Ensure that the separate protective earthing terminal provided on this device is
permanently connected to earth.
• Replace fuses only with fuses of the same type and rating.
• Do not open or remove chassis covers or sheet-metal parts unless instructions are
provided in the hardware documentation for this device. Such an action could cause
severe electrical shock.
• Do not push or force any objects through any opening in the chassis frame. Such an
action could result in electrical shock or fire.
• Avoid spilling liquid onto the chassis or onto any device component. Such an action
could cause electrical shock or damage the device.
• Avoid touching uninsulated electrical wires or terminals that have not been
disconnected from their power source. Such an action could cause electrical shock.
• Some parts of the chassis, including AC and DC power supply surfaces, power supply
unit handles, SFB card handles, and fan tray handles might become hot. The following
label provides the warning of the hot surfaces on the chassis:
• Always ensure that all modules, power supplies, and cover panels are fully inserted
and that the installation screws are fully tightened.
NOTE: You might find this information helpful in a particular situation, or you
might overlook this important information if it was not highlighted in a Note.
WARNING: This symbol alerts you to the risk of personal injury from a laser.
WARNING: This symbol means danger. You are in a situation that could cause
bodily injury. Before you work on any equipment, be aware of the hazards
involved with electrical circuitry and be familiar with standard practices for
preventing accidents.
Aviso Este símbolo de aviso indica perigo. Encontra-se numa situação que
lhe poderá causar danos físicos. Antes de começar a trabalhar com qualquer
equipamento, familiarize-se com os perigos relacionados com circuitos
eléctricos, e com quaisquer práticas comuns que possam prevenir possíveis
acidentes.
WARNING: Only trained and qualified personnel should install or replace the
device.
Advarsel Kun kvalifisert personell med riktig opplæring bør montere eller
bytte ut dette utstyret.
In addition, you should establish procedures to protect your equipment in the event of a
fire emergency. Juniper Networks products should be installed in an environment suitable
for electronic equipment. We recommend that fire suppression equipment be available
in the event of a fire in the vicinity of the equipment and that all local fire, safety, and
electrical codes and ordinances be observed when you install and operate your equipment.
Fire Suppression
In the event of an electrical hazard or an electrical fire, you should first turn power off to
the equipment at the source. Then use a Type C fire extinguisher, which uses noncorrosive
fire retardants, to extinguish the fire.
Type C fire extinguishers, which use noncorrosive fire retardants such as carbon dioxide
and Halotron™, are most effective for suppressing electrical fires. Type C fire extinguishers
displace oxygen from the point of combustion to eliminate the fire. For extinguishing fire
on or around equipment that draws air from the environment for cooling, you should use
this type of inert oxygen displacement extinguisher instead of an extinguisher that leaves
residues on equipment.
Do not use multipurpose Type ABC chemical fire extinguishers (dry chemical fire
extinguishers). The primary ingredient in these fire extinguishers is monoammonium
phosphate, which is very sticky and difficult to clean. In addition, in the presence of minute
amounts of moisture, monoammonium phosphate can become highly corrosive and
corrodes most metals.
Any equipment in a room in which a chemical fire extinguisher has been discharged is
subject to premature failure and unreliable operation. The equipment is considered to
be irreparably damaged.
NOTE: To keep warranties effective, do not use a dry chemical fire extinguisher
to control a fire at or near a Juniper Networks device. If a dry chemical fire
extinguisher is used, the unit is no longer eligible for coverage under a service
agreement.
WARNING: Read the installation instructions before you connect the device
to a power source.
• Before lifting or moving the device, disconnect all external cables and wires.
• As when lifting any heavy object, ensure that most of the weight is borne by your legs
rather than your back. Keep your knees bent and your back relatively straight. Do not
twist your body as you lift. Balance the load evenly and be sure that your footing is firm.
• Above 121.2 lbs (55 kg): Material handling systems (such as levers, slings, lifts and
so on) must be used. When this is not practical, specially trained persons or systems
must be used (riggers or movers).
Ramp Warning
WARNING: When installing the device, do not use a ramp inclined at more
than 10 degrees.
Waarschuwing Gebruik een oprijplaat niet onder een hoek van meer dan 10
graden.
Varoitus Älä käytä sellaista kaltevaa pintaa, jonka kaltevuus ylittää 10 astetta.
Warnung Keine Rampen mit einer Neigung von mehr als 10 Grad verwenden.
Aviso Não utilize uma rampa com uma inclinação superior a 10 graus.
• The device should be mounted at the bottom of the rack if it is the only unit
in the rack.
• When mounting the device on a partially filled rack, load the rack from the
bottom to the top with the heaviest component at the bottom of the rack.
• Dit toestel dient onderaan in het rek gemonteerd te worden als het toestel
het enige in het rek is.
• Wanneer u dit toestel in een gedeeltelijk gevuld rek monteert, dient u het
rek van onderen naar boven te laden met het zwaarste onderdeel onderaan
in het rek.
Varoitus Kun laite asetetaan telineeseen tai huolletaan sen ollessa telineessä,
on noudatettava erityisiä varotoimia järjestelmän vakavuuden säilyttämiseksi,
jotta vältytään loukkaantumiselta. Noudata seuraavia turvallisuusohjeita:
• Le rack sur lequel est monté le Juniper Networks switch doit être fixé à la
structure du bâtiment.
• Si cette unité constitue la seule unité montée en casier, elle doit être placée
dans le bas.
• Der Juniper Networks switch muß in einem Gestell installiert werden, das
in der Gebäudestruktur verankert ist.
• Wenn diese Einheit die einzige im Gestell ist, sollte sie unten im Gestell
angebracht werden.
• Bei Anbringung dieser Einheit in einem zum Teil gefüllten Gestell ist das
Gestell von unten nach oben zu laden, wobei das schwerste Bauteil unten
im Gestell anzubringen ist.
• Questa unità deve venire montata sul fondo del supporto, se si tratta
dell'unica unità da montare nel supporto.
• Denne enheten bør monteres nederst i kabinettet hvis dette er den eneste
enheten i kabinettet.
• Esta unidade deverá ser montada na parte inferior da estante, caso seja
esta a única unidade a ser montada.
Attention Cet équipement doit être relié à la terre. S'assurer que l'appareil
hôte est relié à la terre lors de l'utilisation normale.
Warnung Dieses Gerät muß geerdet werden. Stellen Sie sicher, daß das
Host-Gerät während des normalen Betriebs an Erde gelegt ist.
Aviso Este equipamento deverá estar ligado à terra. Certifique-se que o host
se encontra ligado à terra durante a sua utilização normal.
When working around ports that support optical transceivers, observe the following
safety guidelines to prevent eye injury:
• Do not look into unterminated ports or at fibers that connect to unknown sources.
WARNING: Do not stare into the laser beam or view it directly with optical
instruments.
Varoitus Älä katso säteeseen äläkä tarkastele sitä suoraan optisen laitteen
avulla.
Warnung Nicht direkt in den Strahl blicken und ihn nicht direkt mit optischen
Geräten prüfen.
Avvertenza Non fissare il raggio con gli occhi né usare strumenti ottici per
osservarlo direttamente.
Aviso Não olhe fixamente para o raio, nem olhe para ele directamente com
instrumentos ópticos.
Varning! Rikta inte blicken in mot strålen och titta inte direkt på den genom
optiska instrument.
Avvertenza Quando i cavi in fibra non sono inseriti, radiazioni invisibili possono
essere emesse attraverso l'apertura della porta. Evitate di esporvi alle
radiazioni e non guardate direttamente nelle aperture.
Advarsel Unngå utsettelse for stråling, og stirr ikke inn i åpninger som er åpne,
fordi usynlig stråling kan emiteres fra portens åpning når det ikke er tilkoblet
en fiberkabel.
¡Atención! Debido a que la apertura del puerto puede emitir radiación invisible
cuando no existe un cable de fibra conectado, evite mirar directamente a las
aperturas para no exponerse a la radiación.
Advarsel Det kan være fare for eksplosjon hvis batteriet skiftes på feil måte.
Skift kun med samme eller tilsvarende type som er anbefalt av produsenten.
Kasser brukte batterier i henhold til produsentens instruksjoner.
Warnung Vor der Arbeit an Geräten, die an das Netz angeschlossen sind,
jeglichen Schmuck (einschließlich Ringe, Ketten und Uhren) abnehmen.
Metallgegenstände erhitzen sich, wenn sie an das Netz und die Erde
angeschlossen werden, und können schwere Verbrennungen verursachen
oder an die Anschlußklemmen angeschweißt werden.
Waarschuwing Tijdens onweer dat gepaard gaat met bliksem, dient u niet
aan het systeem te werken of kabels aan te sluiten of te ontkoppelen.
Warnung Arbeiten Sie nicht am System und schließen Sie keine Kabel an
bzw. trennen Sie keine ab, wenn es gewittert.
Advarsel Utfør aldri arbeid på systemet, eller koble kabler til eller fra systemet
når det tordner eller lyner.
Varning! Vid åska skall du aldrig utföra arbete på systemet eller ansluta eller
koppla loss kablar.
Warnung Um einen Router der switch vor Überhitzung zu schützen, darf dieser
nicht in einer Gegend betrieben werden, in der die Umgebungstemperatur
das empfohlene Maximum von 40° C überschreitet. Um Lüftungsverschluß
zu verhindern, achten Sie darauf, daß mindestens 15,2 cm lichter Raum um
die Lüftungsöffnungen herum frei bleibt.
Varning! Förhindra att en Juniper Networks switch överhettas genom att inte
använda den i ett område där den maximalt rekommenderade
omgivningstemperaturen på 40° C överskrids. Förhindra att luftcirkulationen
inskränks genom att se till att det finns fritt utrymme på minst 15,2 cm omkring
ventilationsöppningarna.
¡Atención! El desecho final de este producto debe realizarse según todas las
leyes y regulaciones nacionales
Varning! Slutlig kassering av denna produkt bör skötas i enlighet med landets
alla lagar och föreskrifter.
WARNING: Certain ports on the device are designed for use as intrabuilding
(within-the-building) interfaces only (Type 2 or Type 4 ports as described in
GR-1089-CORE) and require isolation from the exposed outside plant (OSP)
cabling. To comply with NEBS requirements and protect against lightning
surges and commercial power disturbances, the intrabuilding ports must not
be metallically connected to interfaces that connect to the OSP or its wiring.
The intrabuilding ports on the device are suitable for connection to
intrabuilding or unexposed wiring or cabling only. The addition of primary
protectors is not sufficient protection for connecting these interfaces
metallically to OSP wiring.
• Install the device in compliance with the following local, national, and international
electrical codes:
• Locate the emergency power-off switch for the room in which you are working so that
if an electrical accident occurs, you can quickly turn off the power.
• Make sure that grounding surfaces are cleaned and brought to a bright finish before
grounding connections are made.
• Do not work alone if potentially hazardous conditions exist anywhere in your workspace.
• Never assume that power is disconnected from a circuit. Always check the circuit before
starting to work.
• Carefully look for possible hazards in your work area, such as moist floors, ungrounded
power extension cords, and missing safety grounds.
• Operate the device within marked electrical ratings and product usage instructions.
• To ensure that the device and peripheral equipment function safely and correctly, use
the cables and connectors specified for the attached peripheral equipment, and make
certain they are in good condition.
You can remove and replace many device components without powering off or
disconnecting power to the device, as detailed elsewhere in the hardware documentation
for this device. Never install equipment that appears to be damaged.
• Always use an ESD wrist strap when you are handling components that are subject to
ESD damage, and make sure that it is in direct contact with your skin.
If a grounding strap is not available, hold the component in its antistatic bag (see
Figure 204 on page 546) in one hand and touch the exposed, bare metal of the device
with the other hand immediately before inserting the component into the device.
WARNING: For safety, periodically check the resistance value of the ESD
grounding strap. The measurement must be in the range 1 through
10 Mohms.
• When handling any component that is subject to ESD damage and that is removed
from the device, make sure the equipment end of your ESD wrist strap is attached to
the ESD point on the chassis.
If no grounding strap is available, touch the exposed, bare metal of the device to ground
yourself before handling the component.
• Avoid contact between the component that is subject to ESD damage and your clothing.
ESD voltages emitted from clothing can damage components.
• When removing or installing a component that is subject to ESD damage, always place
it component-side up on an antistatic surface, in an antistatic card rack, or in an
antistatic bag (see Figure 204 on page 546). If you are returning a component, place it
in an antistatic bag before packing it.
CAUTION
ELECTROSTATIC
SENSITIVE
DEVICES
DO NOT OPEN OR HANDLE
EXCEPT AT A
STATIC-FREE WORKSTATION
2
SFP
GE
6x 1
“CAUTION: THIS UNIT HAS MORE THAN ONE POWER SUPPLY CORD. DISCONNECT
ALL POWER SUPPLY CORDS BEFORE SERVICING TO AVOID ELECTRIC SHOCK.”
• AC-powered devices are shipped with a three-wire electrical cord with a grounding-type
plug that fits only a grounding-type power outlet. Do not circumvent this safety feature.
Equipment grounding must comply with local and national electrical codes.
• You must provide an external certified circuit breaker (2-pole circuit breaker or 4-pole
circuit breaker based on your device) rated minimum 20 A in the building installation.
• The power cord serves as the main disconnecting device for the AC-powered device.
The socket outlet must be near the AC-powered device and be easily accessible.
• For devices that have more than one power supply connection, you must ensure that
all power connections are fully disconnected so that power to the device is completely
removed to prevent electric shock. To disconnect power, unplug all power cords (one
for each power supply).
WARNING: The attached power cable is only for this product. Do not use the cable for another product.
WARNING: Before working on the device or near power supplies, unplug all
the power cords from an AC-powered device.
Warnung Bevor Sie an einem Chassis oder in der Nähe von Netzgeräten
arbeiten, ziehen Sie bei Wechselstromeinheiten das Netzkabel ab bzw.
Advarsel Før det utføres arbeid på kabinettet eller det arbeides i nærheten
av strømforsyningsenheter, skal strømledningen trekkes ut på
vekselstrømsenheter.
WARNING: When you install the device, the ground connection must always
be made first and disconnected last.
Warnung Der Erdanschluß muß bei der Installation der Einheit immer zuerst
hergestellt und zuletzt abgetrennt werden.
WARNING: Wire the DC power supply using the appropriate lugs. When
connecting power, the proper wiring sequence is ground to ground, +RTN to
+RTN, then –48 V to –48 V. When disconnecting power, the proper wiring
sequence is –48 V to –48 V, +RTN to +RTN, then ground to ground. Note
that the ground wire must always be connected first and disconnected last.
Warnung Die Stromzufuhr ist nur mit geeigneten Ringösen an das DC Netzteil
anzuschliessen. Die richtige Anschlusssequenz ist: Erdanschluss zu
Erdanschluss, +RTN zu +RTN und dann -48V zu -48V. Die richtige Sequenz
zum Abtrennen der Stromversorgung ist -48V zu -48V, +RTN zu +RTN und
dann Erdanschluss zu Erdanschluss. Es ist zu beachten dass der Erdanschluss
immer zuerst angeschlossen und als letztes abgetrennt wird.
Advarsel Riktig tilkoples tilkoplingssekvens er jord til jord, +RTN til +RTN,
–48 V til – 48 V. Riktig frakoples tilkoplingssekvens er –48 V til – 48 V, +RTN
til +RTN, jord til jord.
Varning! Korrekt kopplingssekvens ar jord till jord, +RTN till +RTN, –48 V till
–48 V. Korrekt kopplas kopplingssekvens ar –48 V till –48 V, +RTN till +RTN,
jord till jord.
Attention Quand des fils torsadés sont nécessaires, utiliser des douilles
terminales homologuées telles que celles à circuit fermé ou du type à plage
ouverte avec cosses rebroussées. Ces douilles terminales doivent être de la
taille qui convient aux fils et doivent être refermées sur la gaine isolante et
sur le conducteur.
lengüetas de conexión vueltas hacia arriba. Estos terminales deberán ser del
tamaño apropiado para los cables que se utilicen, y tendrán que sujetar tanto
el aislante como el conductor.
WARNING: High levels of electrical energy are distributed across the midplane.
Be careful not to contact the midplane connectors, or any component
connected to the midplane, with any metallic object while servicing
components.
WARNING: The network device has more than one power supply connection.
All connections must be removed completely to remove power from the unit
completely.
Warnung Diese Einheit verfügt über mehr als einen Stromanschluß; um Strom
gänzlich von der Einheit fernzuhalten, müssen alle Stromzufuhren abgetrennt
sein.
1. Use caution. Be aware of potentially hazardous conditions that could cause further
injury.
3. If possible, send another person to get medical aid. Otherwise, assess the condition
of the victim, then call for help.
• Safety
• EMC/EMI/ETSI
• Immunity
• EN-61000-3-3 +A1 +A2 +A3 Power Line Voltage Fluctuations and Flicker
• EN-61000-4-5 Surge
• NEBS
See Also • Compliance Statements for NEBS for the MX960 Router on page 555
• Compliance Statements for EMC Requirements for the MX960 Router on page 556
• Compliance Statements for Acoustic Noise for the MX960 Router on page 557
• The equipment is suitable for installation in locations where the National Electrical
Code (NEC) applies.
• The battery return connection is to be treated as an isolated DC return (that is, DC-I),
as defined in GR-1089-CORE.
• You must provision a readily accessible device outside of the equipment to disconnect
power. The device must also be rated based on local electrical code practice.
• Compliance Statements for EMC Requirements for the MX960 Router on page 556
• Compliance Statements for Acoustic Noise for the MX960 Router on page 557
Canada
European Community
This is a Class A product. In a domestic environment, this product might cause radio
interference in which case the user might be required to take adequate measures.
Israel
Japan
This is a Class A product based on the standard of the Voluntary Control Council for
Interference by Information Technology Equipment (VCCI). If this product is used near
a radio or television receiver in a domestic environment, it might cause radio interference.
Install and use the equipment according to the instruction manual. VCCI-A.
United States
The hardware equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class
A digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide
reasonable protection against harmful interference when the equipment is operated in
a commercial environment. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio
frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instruction manual,
might cause harmful interference to radio communications. Operation of this equipment
in a residential area is likely to cause harmful interference in which case the user will be
required to correct the interference at his own expense.
• Compliance Statements for NEBS for the MX960 Router on page 555
• Compliance Statements for EMC Requirements for the MX960 Router on page 556
NOTE: Statements of volatility are not available for all Juniper Networks
devices.
CTP Series:
• CTP2000
EX Series:
• EX2300-C
• EX3300
• EX4200
• EX4300
• EX4300-48MP
• EX4500
• EX4550
• EX4600
• EX8200
LN Series:
• LN1000–CC
MX Series:
• M7i
• M320
QFX Series:
• QFX3008-I
• QFX3100
• QFX3500
• QFX3600
• QFX5100-24Q
• QFX5100-48S
• QFX5100-48T
• QFX5110-32Q
• QFX5110-48S
• QFX5200
• QFX5200-32C
SRX Series:
• SRX100
• SRX110
• SRX210B
• SRX210H-POE
• SRX210H-P-MGW
• SRX220
• SRX240H
• SRX240H-POE
• SRX300
• SRX320
• SRX550
• SRX650
• SRX1400
• SRX1500
• SRX-MP-1SERIAL
• SSG-520M
T Series: